Mercurial > emacs
annotate src/dispnew.c @ 89191:06c052d0f579
*** empty log message ***
| author | Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org> |
|---|---|
| date | Thu, 10 Oct 2002 09:03:32 +0000 |
| parents | aac41b50c875 |
| children | 2f877ed80fa6 |
| rev | line source |
|---|---|
| 314 | 1 /* Updating of data structures for redisplay. |
|
36392
88b90fa71d23
Check HAVE_TERM_H before including term.h.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36279
diff
changeset
|
2 Copyright (C) 1985, 86, 87, 88, 93, 94, 95, 97, 98, 1999, 2000, 2001 |
|
18853
4501a367a887
(direct_output_forward_char): Reenable check against
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
18774
diff
changeset
|
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc. |
| 314 | 4 |
| 5 This file is part of GNU Emacs. | |
| 6 | |
| 7 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify | |
| 8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by | |
|
1777
4edfaa19c7a7
* window.c (window_internal_width): New function.
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1766
diff
changeset
|
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) |
| 314 | 10 any later version. |
| 11 | |
| 12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, | |
| 13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of | |
| 14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the | |
| 15 GNU General Public License for more details. | |
| 16 | |
| 17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License | |
| 18 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to | |
|
14186
ee40177f6c68
Update FSF's address in the preamble.
Erik Naggum <erik@naggum.no>
parents:
14125
diff
changeset
|
19 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, |
|
ee40177f6c68
Update FSF's address in the preamble.
Erik Naggum <erik@naggum.no>
parents:
14125
diff
changeset
|
20 Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */ |
| 314 | 21 |
|
26088
b7aa6ac26872
Add support for large files, 64-bit Solaris, system locale codings.
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents:
25781
diff
changeset
|
22 #include <config.h> |
| 314 | 23 #include <signal.h> |
|
7900
60795e826dad
Put stdio.h after config.h.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7814
diff
changeset
|
24 #include <stdio.h> |
| 314 | 25 #include <ctype.h> |
| 26 | |
| 21514 | 27 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H |
| 28 #include <unistd.h> | |
| 29 #endif | |
| 30 | |
|
3525
58e789baa27a
Include lisp.h earlier (before termhooks.h).
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
3517
diff
changeset
|
31 #include "lisp.h" |
| 314 | 32 #include "termchar.h" |
| 33 #include "termopts.h" | |
| 2198 | 34 #include "termhooks.h" |
|
13526
34382f4e23cb
Always include dispextern.h before cm.h.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13448
diff
changeset
|
35 /* cm.h must come after dispextern.h on Windows. */ |
|
13408
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
36 #include "dispextern.h" |
|
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
37 #include "cm.h" |
| 314 | 38 #include "buffer.h" |
|
88351
aac41b50c875
Include "character.h" instead of "charset.h".
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
42835
diff
changeset
|
39 #include "character.h" |
|
31093
6da961dff718
Include keyboard.h before frame.h.
Andrew Innes <andrewi@gnu.org>
parents:
30720
diff
changeset
|
40 #include "keyboard.h" |
| 764 | 41 #include "frame.h" |
| 314 | 42 #include "window.h" |
| 43 #include "commands.h" | |
| 44 #include "disptab.h" | |
| 45 #include "indent.h" | |
|
4384
98605d0ea3cf
(direct_output_for_insert): Fail if character
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
4290
diff
changeset
|
46 #include "intervals.h" |
| 15065 | 47 #include "blockinput.h" |
| 21514 | 48 #include "process.h" |
| 314 | 49 |
|
17015
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
50 /* I don't know why DEC Alpha OSF1 fail to compile this file if we |
|
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
51 include the following file. */ |
|
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
52 /* #include "systty.h" */ |
| 12917 | 53 #include "syssignal.h" |
| 554 | 54 |
| 314 | 55 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS |
| 56 #include "xterm.h" | |
| 25012 | 57 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */ |
| 314 | 58 |
|
13408
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
59 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI |
|
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
60 #include "w32term.h" |
|
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
61 #endif /* HAVE_NTGUI */ |
|
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
62 |
|
32752
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
63 #ifdef macintosh |
|
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
64 #include "macterm.h" |
|
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
65 #endif /* macintosh */ |
|
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
66 |
| 25012 | 67 /* Include systime.h after xterm.h to avoid double inclusion of time.h. */ |
| 68 | |
|
7808
52e2eb6245d4
Include systime.h after xterm.h.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7648
diff
changeset
|
69 #include "systime.h" |
|
7558
8497bcb9fb8e
(PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT): If __GNU_LIBRARY__,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7530
diff
changeset
|
70 #include <errno.h> |
|
8497bcb9fb8e
(PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT): If __GNU_LIBRARY__,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7530
diff
changeset
|
71 |
| 25012 | 72 /* To get the prototype for `sleep'. */ |
| 73 | |
| 74 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H | |
| 75 #include <unistd.h> | |
| 76 #endif | |
| 77 | |
| 314 | 78 /* Get number of chars of output now in the buffer of a stdio stream. |
| 25012 | 79 This ought to be built in in stdio, but it isn't. Some s- files |
| 80 override this because their stdio internals differ. */ | |
| 81 | |
|
5214
c4bf07b226be
(PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT) [__GNU_LIBRARY__]: Alternate definition for the GNU
Roland McGrath <roland@gnu.org>
parents:
5083
diff
changeset
|
82 #ifdef __GNU_LIBRARY__ |
| 25012 | 83 |
| 84 /* The s- file might have overridden the definition with one that | |
| 85 works for the system's C library. But we are using the GNU C | |
| 86 library, so this is the right definition for every system. */ | |
| 87 | |
|
7558
8497bcb9fb8e
(PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT): If __GNU_LIBRARY__,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7530
diff
changeset
|
88 #ifdef GNU_LIBRARY_PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT |
|
8497bcb9fb8e
(PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT): If __GNU_LIBRARY__,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7530
diff
changeset
|
89 #define PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT GNU_LIBRARY_PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT |
|
8497bcb9fb8e
(PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT): If __GNU_LIBRARY__,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7530
diff
changeset
|
90 #else |
|
7443
a9cb818e5316
[__GNU_LIBRARY__]: Redefine PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT even if already defined.
Roland McGrath <roland@gnu.org>
parents:
7247
diff
changeset
|
91 #undef PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT |
|
5214
c4bf07b226be
(PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT) [__GNU_LIBRARY__]: Alternate definition for the GNU
Roland McGrath <roland@gnu.org>
parents:
5083
diff
changeset
|
92 #define PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT(FILE) ((FILE)->__bufp - (FILE)->__buffer) |
|
7558
8497bcb9fb8e
(PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT): If __GNU_LIBRARY__,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7530
diff
changeset
|
93 #endif |
|
8497bcb9fb8e
(PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT): If __GNU_LIBRARY__,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7530
diff
changeset
|
94 #else /* not __GNU_LIBRARY__ */ |
|
26088
b7aa6ac26872
Add support for large files, 64-bit Solaris, system locale codings.
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents:
25781
diff
changeset
|
95 #if !defined (PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT) && HAVE_STDIO_EXT_H && HAVE___FPENDING |
|
b7aa6ac26872
Add support for large files, 64-bit Solaris, system locale codings.
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents:
25781
diff
changeset
|
96 #include <stdio_ext.h> |
|
b7aa6ac26872
Add support for large files, 64-bit Solaris, system locale codings.
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents:
25781
diff
changeset
|
97 #define PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT(FILE) __fpending (FILE) |
|
b7aa6ac26872
Add support for large files, 64-bit Solaris, system locale codings.
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents:
25781
diff
changeset
|
98 #endif |
|
7443
a9cb818e5316
[__GNU_LIBRARY__]: Redefine PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT even if already defined.
Roland McGrath <roland@gnu.org>
parents:
7247
diff
changeset
|
99 #ifndef PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT |
| 314 | 100 #define PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT(FILE) ((FILE)->_ptr - (FILE)->_base) |
| 101 #endif | |
| 25012 | 102 #endif /* not __GNU_LIBRARY__ */ |
| 103 | |
|
41969
e669966d496e
Test GNU_LINUX, not LINUX.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
41120
diff
changeset
|
104 #if defined(HAVE_TERM_H) && defined (GNU_LINUX) && defined (HAVE_LIBNCURSES) |
| 29437 | 105 #include <term.h> /* for tgetent */ |
| 106 #endif | |
| 25012 | 107 |
| 108 /* Structure to pass dimensions around. Used for character bounding | |
| 109 boxes, glyph matrix dimensions and alike. */ | |
| 110 | |
| 111 struct dim | |
| 112 { | |
| 113 int width; | |
| 114 int height; | |
| 115 }; | |
| 116 | |
| 117 | |
| 118 /* Function prototypes. */ | |
| 119 | |
|
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
120 static struct glyph_matrix *save_current_matrix P_ ((struct frame *)); |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
121 static void restore_current_matrix P_ ((struct frame *, struct glyph_matrix *)); |
|
34736
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
122 static void fake_current_matrices P_ ((Lisp_Object)); |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
123 static void redraw_overlapping_rows P_ ((struct window *, int)); |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
124 static void redraw_overlapped_rows P_ ((struct window *, int)); |
| 25012 | 125 static int count_blanks P_ ((struct glyph *, int)); |
| 126 static int count_match P_ ((struct glyph *, struct glyph *, | |
| 127 struct glyph *, struct glyph *)); | |
| 128 static unsigned line_draw_cost P_ ((struct glyph_matrix *, int)); | |
| 129 static void update_frame_line P_ ((struct frame *, int)); | |
| 130 static struct dim allocate_matrices_for_frame_redisplay | |
|
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
131 P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int, int *)); |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
132 static void allocate_matrices_for_window_redisplay P_ ((struct window *)); |
| 25012 | 133 static int realloc_glyph_pool P_ ((struct glyph_pool *, struct dim)); |
| 134 static void adjust_frame_glyphs P_ ((struct frame *)); | |
| 135 struct glyph_matrix *new_glyph_matrix P_ ((struct glyph_pool *)); | |
| 136 static void free_glyph_matrix P_ ((struct glyph_matrix *)); | |
| 137 static void adjust_glyph_matrix P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_matrix *, | |
| 138 int, int, struct dim)); | |
|
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
139 static void change_frame_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int, int)); |
| 25012 | 140 static void swap_glyph_pointers P_ ((struct glyph_row *, struct glyph_row *)); |
|
34895
53e52b3525bf
Use #if GLYPH_DEBUG instead of #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34893
diff
changeset
|
141 #if GLYPH_DEBUG |
| 25012 | 142 static int glyph_row_slice_p P_ ((struct glyph_row *, struct glyph_row *)); |
|
30323
4cd1b8fe118c
(direct_output_for_insert): Remove confusing
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30307
diff
changeset
|
143 #endif |
| 25012 | 144 static void fill_up_frame_row_with_spaces P_ ((struct glyph_row *, int)); |
| 145 static void build_frame_matrix_from_window_tree P_ ((struct glyph_matrix *, | |
| 146 struct window *)); | |
| 147 static void build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window P_ ((struct glyph_matrix *, | |
| 148 struct window *)); | |
| 149 static struct glyph_pool *new_glyph_pool P_ ((void)); | |
| 150 static void free_glyph_pool P_ ((struct glyph_pool *)); | |
| 151 static void adjust_frame_glyphs_initially P_ ((void)); | |
| 152 static void adjust_frame_message_buffer P_ ((struct frame *)); | |
| 153 static void adjust_decode_mode_spec_buffer P_ ((struct frame *)); | |
| 154 static void fill_up_glyph_row_with_spaces P_ ((struct glyph_row *)); | |
| 155 static void build_frame_matrix P_ ((struct frame *)); | |
| 156 void clear_current_matrices P_ ((struct frame *)); | |
| 157 void scroll_glyph_matrix_range P_ ((struct glyph_matrix *, int, int, | |
| 158 int, int)); | |
| 159 static void clear_window_matrices P_ ((struct window *, int)); | |
| 160 static void fill_up_glyph_row_area_with_spaces P_ ((struct glyph_row *, int)); | |
| 161 static int scrolling_window P_ ((struct window *, int)); | |
|
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
162 static int update_window_line P_ ((struct window *, int, int *)); |
| 25012 | 163 static void update_marginal_area P_ ((struct window *, int, int)); |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
164 static int update_text_area P_ ((struct window *, int)); |
| 25012 | 165 static void make_current P_ ((struct glyph_matrix *, struct glyph_matrix *, |
| 166 int)); | |
| 167 static void mirror_make_current P_ ((struct window *, int)); | |
| 168 void check_window_matrix_pointers P_ ((struct window *)); | |
|
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
169 #if GLYPH_DEBUG |
| 25012 | 170 static void check_matrix_pointers P_ ((struct glyph_matrix *, |
| 171 struct glyph_matrix *)); | |
|
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
172 #endif |
| 25012 | 173 static void mirror_line_dance P_ ((struct window *, int, int, int *, char *)); |
| 174 static int update_window_tree P_ ((struct window *, int)); | |
| 175 static int update_window P_ ((struct window *, int)); | |
| 176 static int update_frame_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int)); | |
| 177 static void set_window_cursor_after_update P_ ((struct window *)); | |
| 178 static int row_equal_p P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, | |
|
30152
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
179 struct glyph_row *, int)); |
| 25012 | 180 static void adjust_frame_glyphs_for_window_redisplay P_ ((struct frame *)); |
| 181 static void adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay P_ ((struct frame *)); | |
| 182 static void reverse_rows P_ ((struct glyph_matrix *, int, int)); | |
| 183 static int margin_glyphs_to_reserve P_ ((struct window *, int, Lisp_Object)); | |
|
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
184 static void sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows P_ ((struct window *)); |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
185 struct window *frame_row_to_window P_ ((struct window *, int)); |
| 25012 | 186 |
| 187 | |
| 188 /* Non-zero means don't pause redisplay for pending input. (This is | |
| 189 for debugging and for a future implementation of EDT-like | |
| 190 scrolling. */ | |
| 191 | |
| 192 int redisplay_dont_pause; | |
|
10770
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
193 |
| 554 | 194 /* Nonzero upon entry to redisplay means do not assume anything about |
| 764 | 195 current contents of actual terminal frame; clear and redraw it. */ |
| 314 | 196 |
| 764 | 197 int frame_garbaged; |
| 314 | 198 |
| 25012 | 199 /* Nonzero means last display completed. Zero means it was preempted. */ |
| 314 | 200 |
| 201 int display_completed; | |
| 202 | |
| 25012 | 203 /* Lisp variable visible-bell; enables use of screen-flash instead of |
| 204 audible bell. */ | |
| 314 | 205 |
| 206 int visible_bell; | |
| 207 | |
| 764 | 208 /* Invert the color of the whole frame, at a low level. */ |
| 314 | 209 |
| 210 int inverse_video; | |
| 211 | |
| 212 /* Line speed of the terminal. */ | |
| 213 | |
| 214 int baud_rate; | |
| 215 | |
| 25012 | 216 /* Either nil or a symbol naming the window system under which Emacs |
| 217 is running. */ | |
| 314 | 218 |
| 219 Lisp_Object Vwindow_system; | |
| 220 | |
| 221 /* Version number of X windows: 10, 11 or nil. */ | |
| 25012 | 222 |
| 314 | 223 Lisp_Object Vwindow_system_version; |
| 224 | |
| 25012 | 225 /* Vector of glyph definitions. Indexed by glyph number, the contents |
| 226 are a string which is how to output the glyph. | |
| 314 | 227 |
| 228 If Vglyph_table is nil, a glyph is output by using its low 8 bits | |
| 25012 | 229 as a character code. |
| 230 | |
| 231 This is an obsolete feature that is no longer used. The variable | |
| 232 is retained for compatibility. */ | |
| 314 | 233 |
| 234 Lisp_Object Vglyph_table; | |
| 235 | |
| 236 /* Display table to use for vectors that don't specify their own. */ | |
| 237 | |
| 238 Lisp_Object Vstandard_display_table; | |
| 239 | |
| 25012 | 240 /* Nonzero means reading single-character input with prompt so put |
|
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
241 cursor on mini-buffer after the prompt. Positive means at end of |
| 25012 | 242 text in echo area; negative means at beginning of line. */ |
| 243 | |
| 314 | 244 int cursor_in_echo_area; |
|
13220
2e9014617492
(Qdisplay_table): New variable.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13105
diff
changeset
|
245 |
|
30720
64f3338f72d8
(Qredisplay_dont_pause): New variable.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30713
diff
changeset
|
246 Lisp_Object Qdisplay_table, Qredisplay_dont_pause; |
| 25012 | 247 |
| 314 | 248 |
| 25012 | 249 /* The currently selected frame. In a single-frame version, this |
|
25666
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
250 variable always equals the_only_frame. */ |
|
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
251 |
|
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
252 Lisp_Object selected_frame; |
| 25012 | 253 |
| 254 /* A frame which is not just a mini-buffer, or 0 if there are no such | |
| 764 | 255 frames. This is usually the most recent such frame that was |
| 9572 | 256 selected. In a single-frame version, this variable always holds |
| 257 the address of the_only_frame. */ | |
| 25012 | 258 |
| 259 struct frame *last_nonminibuf_frame; | |
| 260 | |
| 261 /* Stdio stream being used for copy of all output. */ | |
| 262 | |
| 263 FILE *termscript; | |
| 264 | |
| 265 /* Structure for info on cursor positioning. */ | |
| 266 | |
| 267 struct cm Wcm; | |
| 268 | |
| 269 /* 1 means SIGWINCH happened when not safe. */ | |
| 270 | |
| 271 int delayed_size_change; | |
| 272 | |
| 273 /* 1 means glyph initialization has been completed at startup. */ | |
| 274 | |
| 275 static int glyphs_initialized_initially_p; | |
| 276 | |
| 277 /* Updated window if != 0. Set by update_window. */ | |
| 278 | |
| 279 struct window *updated_window; | |
| 280 | |
| 281 /* Glyph row updated in update_window_line, and area that is updated. */ | |
| 282 | |
| 283 struct glyph_row *updated_row; | |
| 284 int updated_area; | |
| 285 | |
| 286 /* A glyph for a space. */ | |
| 287 | |
| 288 struct glyph space_glyph; | |
| 289 | |
| 290 /* Non-zero means update has been performed directly, so that there's | |
| 291 no need for redisplay_internal to do much work. Set by | |
| 292 direct_output_for_insert. */ | |
| 293 | |
| 294 int redisplay_performed_directly_p; | |
| 295 | |
| 296 /* Counts of allocated structures. These counts serve to diagnose | |
| 297 memory leaks and double frees. */ | |
| 298 | |
| 299 int glyph_matrix_count; | |
| 300 int glyph_pool_count; | |
| 301 | |
| 302 /* If non-null, the frame whose frame matrices are manipulated. If | |
| 303 null, window matrices are worked on. */ | |
| 304 | |
| 305 static struct frame *frame_matrix_frame; | |
| 306 | |
| 307 /* Current interface for window-based redisplay. Set from init_xterm. | |
| 308 A null value means we are not using window-based redisplay. */ | |
| 309 | |
| 310 struct redisplay_interface *rif; | |
| 311 | |
| 312 /* Non-zero means that fonts have been loaded since the last glyph | |
| 313 matrix adjustments. Redisplay must stop, and glyph matrices must | |
| 314 be adjusted when this flag becomes non-zero during display. The | |
| 315 reason fonts can be loaded so late is that fonts of fontsets are | |
| 316 loaded on demand. */ | |
| 317 | |
| 318 int fonts_changed_p; | |
| 319 | |
| 320 /* Convert vpos and hpos from frame to window and vice versa. | |
| 321 This may only be used for terminal frames. */ | |
| 322 | |
| 323 #if GLYPH_DEBUG | |
| 324 | |
| 325 static int window_to_frame_vpos P_ ((struct window *, int)); | |
| 326 static int window_to_frame_hpos P_ ((struct window *, int)); | |
| 327 #define WINDOW_TO_FRAME_VPOS(W, VPOS) window_to_frame_vpos ((W), (VPOS)) | |
| 328 #define WINDOW_TO_FRAME_HPOS(W, HPOS) window_to_frame_hpos ((W), (HPOS)) | |
| 329 | |
|
34866
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
330 /* One element of the ring buffer containing redisplay history |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
331 information. */ |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
332 |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
333 struct redisplay_history |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
334 { |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
335 char trace[512 + 100]; |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
336 }; |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
337 |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
338 /* The size of the history buffer. */ |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
339 |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
340 #define REDISPLAY_HISTORY_SIZE 30 |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
341 |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
342 /* The redisplay history buffer. */ |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
343 |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
344 static struct redisplay_history redisplay_history[REDISPLAY_HISTORY_SIZE]; |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
345 |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
346 /* Next free entry in redisplay_history. */ |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
347 |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
348 static int history_idx; |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
349 |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
350 /* A tick that's incremented each time something is added to the |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
351 history. */ |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
352 |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
353 static unsigned history_tick; |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
354 |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
355 static void add_frame_display_history P_ ((struct frame *, int)); |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
356 static void add_window_display_history P_ ((struct window *, char *, int)); |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
357 |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
358 |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
359 /* Add to the redisplay history how window W has been displayed. |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
360 MSG is a trace containing the information how W's glyph matrix |
|
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
361 has been constructed. PAUSED_P non-zero means that the update |
|
34866
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
362 has been interrupted for pending input. */ |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
363 |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
364 static void |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
365 add_window_display_history (w, msg, paused_p) |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
366 struct window *w; |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
367 char *msg; |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
368 int paused_p; |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
369 { |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
370 char *buf; |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
371 |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
372 if (history_idx >= REDISPLAY_HISTORY_SIZE) |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
373 history_idx = 0; |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
374 buf = redisplay_history[history_idx].trace; |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
375 ++history_idx; |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
376 |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
377 sprintf (buf, "%d: window %p (`%s')%s\n", |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
378 history_tick++, |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
379 w, |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
380 ((BUFFERP (w->buffer) |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
381 && STRINGP (XBUFFER (w->buffer)->name)) |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
382 ? (char *) XSTRING (XBUFFER (w->buffer)->name)->data |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
383 : "???"), |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
384 paused_p ? " ***paused***" : ""); |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
385 strcat (buf, msg); |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
386 } |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
387 |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
388 |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
389 /* Add to the redisplay history that frame F has been displayed. |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
390 PAUSED_P non-zero means that the update has been interrupted for |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
391 pending input. */ |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
392 |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
393 static void |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
394 add_frame_display_history (f, paused_p) |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
395 struct frame *f; |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
396 int paused_p; |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
397 { |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
398 char *buf; |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
399 |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
400 if (history_idx >= REDISPLAY_HISTORY_SIZE) |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
401 history_idx = 0; |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
402 buf = redisplay_history[history_idx].trace; |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
403 ++history_idx; |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
404 |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
405 sprintf (buf, "%d: update frame %p%s", |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
406 history_tick++, |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
407 f, paused_p ? " ***paused***" : ""); |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
408 } |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
409 |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
410 |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
411 DEFUN ("dump-redisplay-history", Fdump_redisplay_history, |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
412 Sdump_redisplay_history, 0, 0, "", |
|
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
413 doc: /* Dump redisplay history to stderr. */) |
|
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
414 () |
|
34866
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
415 { |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
416 int i; |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
417 |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
418 for (i = history_idx - 1; i != history_idx; --i) |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
419 { |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
420 if (i < 0) |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
421 i = REDISPLAY_HISTORY_SIZE - 1; |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
422 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", redisplay_history[i].trace); |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
423 } |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
424 |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
425 return Qnil; |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
426 } |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
427 |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
428 |
| 25012 | 429 #else /* GLYPH_DEBUG == 0 */ |
| 430 | |
| 431 #define WINDOW_TO_FRAME_VPOS(W, VPOS) ((VPOS) + XFASTINT ((W)->top)) | |
| 432 #define WINDOW_TO_FRAME_HPOS(W, HPOS) ((HPOS) + XFASTINT ((W)->left)) | |
| 433 | |
| 434 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG == 0 */ | |
| 435 | |
| 436 | |
| 437 /* Like bcopy except never gets confused by overlap. Let this be the | |
| 438 first function defined in this file, or change emacs.c where the | |
| 439 address of this function is used. */ | |
| 314 | 440 |
| 441 void | |
| 442 safe_bcopy (from, to, size) | |
| 443 char *from, *to; | |
| 444 int size; | |
| 445 { | |
|
1588
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
446 if (size <= 0 || from == to) |
| 314 | 447 return; |
| 448 | |
|
1588
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
449 /* If the source and destination don't overlap, then bcopy can |
|
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
450 handle it. If they do overlap, but the destination is lower in |
|
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
451 memory than the source, we'll assume bcopy can handle that. */ |
|
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
452 if (to < from || from + size <= to) |
|
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
453 bcopy (from, to, size); |
|
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
454 |
|
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
455 /* Otherwise, we'll copy from the end. */ |
|
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
456 else |
| 314 | 457 { |
|
1588
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
458 register char *endf = from + size; |
|
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
459 register char *endt = to + size; |
| 314 | 460 |
| 461 /* If TO - FROM is large, then we should break the copy into | |
| 462 nonoverlapping chunks of TO - FROM bytes each. However, if | |
| 463 TO - FROM is small, then the bcopy function call overhead | |
| 464 makes this not worth it. The crossover point could be about | |
|
1588
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
465 anywhere. Since I don't think the obvious copy loop is too |
|
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
466 bad, I'm trying to err in its favor. */ |
| 314 | 467 if (to - from < 64) |
| 468 { | |
| 469 do | |
| 470 *--endt = *--endf; | |
| 471 while (endf != from); | |
| 472 } | |
| 473 else | |
| 474 { | |
|
1588
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
475 for (;;) |
| 314 | 476 { |
| 477 endt -= (to - from); | |
| 478 endf -= (to - from); | |
| 479 | |
|
1588
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
480 if (endt < to) |
|
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
481 break; |
|
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
482 |
| 314 | 483 bcopy (endf, endt, to - from); |
| 484 } | |
|
1588
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
485 |
|
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
486 /* If SIZE wasn't a multiple of TO - FROM, there will be a |
| 25012 | 487 little left over. The amount left over is (endt + (to - |
| 488 from)) - to, which is endt - from. */ | |
| 314 | 489 bcopy (from, to, endt - from); |
| 490 } | |
| 491 } | |
| 492 } | |
| 493 | |
| 25012 | 494 |
| 495 | |
| 496 /*********************************************************************** | |
| 497 Glyph Matrices | |
| 498 ***********************************************************************/ | |
| 499 | |
| 500 /* Allocate and return a glyph_matrix structure. POOL is the glyph | |
| 501 pool from which memory for the matrix should be allocated, or null | |
| 502 for window-based redisplay where no glyph pools are used. The | |
| 503 member `pool' of the glyph matrix structure returned is set to | |
| 504 POOL, the structure is otherwise zeroed. */ | |
| 505 | |
| 506 struct glyph_matrix * | |
| 507 new_glyph_matrix (pool) | |
| 508 struct glyph_pool *pool; | |
| 509 { | |
| 510 struct glyph_matrix *result; | |
| 511 | |
| 512 /* Allocate and clear. */ | |
| 513 result = (struct glyph_matrix *) xmalloc (sizeof *result); | |
| 514 bzero (result, sizeof *result); | |
| 515 | |
| 516 /* Increment number of allocated matrices. This count is used | |
| 517 to detect memory leaks. */ | |
| 518 ++glyph_matrix_count; | |
| 519 | |
| 520 /* Set pool and return. */ | |
| 521 result->pool = pool; | |
| 522 return result; | |
| 523 } | |
| 524 | |
| 525 | |
| 526 /* Free glyph matrix MATRIX. Passing in a null MATRIX is allowed. | |
| 527 | |
| 528 The global counter glyph_matrix_count is decremented when a matrix | |
| 529 is freed. If the count gets negative, more structures were freed | |
| 530 than allocated, i.e. one matrix was freed more than once or a bogus | |
| 531 pointer was passed to this function. | |
| 532 | |
| 533 If MATRIX->pool is null, this means that the matrix manages its own | |
| 534 glyph memory---this is done for matrices on X frames. Freeing the | |
| 535 matrix also frees the glyph memory in this case. */ | |
| 536 | |
| 537 static void | |
| 538 free_glyph_matrix (matrix) | |
| 539 struct glyph_matrix *matrix; | |
| 540 { | |
| 541 if (matrix) | |
| 542 { | |
| 543 int i; | |
| 544 | |
| 545 /* Detect the case that more matrices are freed than were | |
| 546 allocated. */ | |
| 547 if (--glyph_matrix_count < 0) | |
| 548 abort (); | |
| 549 | |
| 550 /* Free glyph memory if MATRIX owns it. */ | |
| 551 if (matrix->pool == NULL) | |
| 552 for (i = 0; i < matrix->rows_allocated; ++i) | |
| 553 xfree (matrix->rows[i].glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA]); | |
| 554 | |
| 555 /* Free row structures and the matrix itself. */ | |
| 556 xfree (matrix->rows); | |
| 557 xfree (matrix); | |
| 558 } | |
| 559 } | |
| 560 | |
| 561 | |
| 562 /* Return the number of glyphs to reserve for a marginal area of | |
| 563 window W. TOTAL_GLYPHS is the number of glyphs in a complete | |
| 564 display line of window W. MARGIN gives the width of the marginal | |
| 565 area in canonical character units. MARGIN should be an integer | |
| 566 or a float. */ | |
| 567 | |
| 568 static int | |
| 569 margin_glyphs_to_reserve (w, total_glyphs, margin) | |
| 570 struct window *w; | |
| 571 int total_glyphs; | |
| 572 Lisp_Object margin; | |
| 573 { | |
| 574 int n; | |
| 575 | |
| 576 if (NUMBERP (margin)) | |
| 577 { | |
| 578 int width = XFASTINT (w->width); | |
| 579 double d = max (0, XFLOATINT (margin)); | |
| 580 d = min (width / 2 - 1, d); | |
| 581 n = (int) ((double) total_glyphs / width * d); | |
| 582 } | |
| 583 else | |
| 584 n = 0; | |
| 585 | |
| 586 return n; | |
| 587 } | |
| 588 | |
| 589 | |
| 590 /* Adjust glyph matrix MATRIX on window W or on a frame to changed | |
| 591 window sizes. | |
| 592 | |
| 593 W is null if the function is called for a frame glyph matrix. | |
| 594 Otherwise it is the window MATRIX is a member of. X and Y are the | |
| 595 indices of the first column and row of MATRIX within the frame | |
| 596 matrix, if such a matrix exists. They are zero for purely | |
| 597 window-based redisplay. DIM is the needed size of the matrix. | |
| 598 | |
| 599 In window-based redisplay, where no frame matrices exist, glyph | |
| 600 matrices manage their own glyph storage. Otherwise, they allocate | |
| 601 storage from a common frame glyph pool which can be found in | |
| 602 MATRIX->pool. | |
| 603 | |
| 604 The reason for this memory management strategy is to avoid complete | |
| 605 frame redraws if possible. When we allocate from a common pool, a | |
| 606 change of the location or size of a sub-matrix within the pool | |
| 607 requires a complete redisplay of the frame because we cannot easily | |
| 608 make sure that the current matrices of all windows still agree with | |
| 609 what is displayed on the screen. While this is usually fast, it | |
| 610 leads to screen flickering. */ | |
| 611 | |
| 612 static void | |
| 613 adjust_glyph_matrix (w, matrix, x, y, dim) | |
| 614 struct window *w; | |
| 615 struct glyph_matrix *matrix; | |
| 616 int x, y; | |
| 617 struct dim dim; | |
| 618 { | |
| 619 int i; | |
| 620 int new_rows; | |
| 621 int marginal_areas_changed_p = 0; | |
| 25546 | 622 int header_line_changed_p = 0; |
| 623 int header_line_p = 0; | |
| 25012 | 624 int left = -1, right = -1; |
|
34203
e55480843a8e
(scrolling_window): Fix code inserting runs in list of all runs.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33763
diff
changeset
|
625 int window_x, window_y, window_width = -1, window_height; |
| 25012 | 626 |
|
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
627 /* See if W had a header line that has disappeared now, or vice versa. */ |
| 25012 | 628 if (w) |
| 629 { | |
| 25546 | 630 header_line_p = WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w); |
| 631 header_line_changed_p = header_line_p != matrix->header_line_p; | |
| 25012 | 632 } |
| 25546 | 633 matrix->header_line_p = header_line_p; |
| 25012 | 634 |
| 635 /* Do nothing if MATRIX' size, position, vscroll, and marginal areas | |
| 636 haven't changed. This optimization is important because preserving | |
| 637 the matrix means preventing redisplay. */ | |
| 638 if (matrix->pool == NULL) | |
| 639 { | |
| 640 window_box (w, -1, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, &window_height); | |
| 641 left = margin_glyphs_to_reserve (w, dim.width, w->left_margin_width); | |
| 642 right = margin_glyphs_to_reserve (w, dim.width, w->right_margin_width); | |
| 643 xassert (left >= 0 && right >= 0); | |
| 644 marginal_areas_changed_p = (left != matrix->left_margin_glyphs | |
| 645 || right != matrix->right_margin_glyphs); | |
| 646 | |
| 647 if (!marginal_areas_changed_p | |
| 648 && !fonts_changed_p | |
| 25546 | 649 && !header_line_changed_p |
|
34279
7ab25b4a077c
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Don't reuse a window's current
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34203
diff
changeset
|
650 && matrix->window_left_x == XFASTINT (w->left) |
| 25012 | 651 && matrix->window_top_y == XFASTINT (w->top) |
| 652 && matrix->window_height == window_height | |
| 653 && matrix->window_vscroll == w->vscroll | |
| 654 && matrix->window_width == window_width) | |
| 655 return; | |
| 656 } | |
| 657 | |
| 658 /* Enlarge MATRIX->rows if necessary. New rows are cleared. */ | |
| 659 if (matrix->rows_allocated < dim.height) | |
| 660 { | |
| 661 int size = dim.height * sizeof (struct glyph_row); | |
| 662 new_rows = dim.height - matrix->rows_allocated; | |
| 663 matrix->rows = (struct glyph_row *) xrealloc (matrix->rows, size); | |
| 664 bzero (matrix->rows + matrix->rows_allocated, | |
| 665 new_rows * sizeof *matrix->rows); | |
| 666 matrix->rows_allocated = dim.height; | |
| 667 } | |
| 668 else | |
| 669 new_rows = 0; | |
| 670 | |
| 671 /* If POOL is not null, MATRIX is a frame matrix or a window matrix | |
| 672 on a frame not using window-based redisplay. Set up pointers for | |
| 673 each row into the glyph pool. */ | |
| 674 if (matrix->pool) | |
| 675 { | |
| 676 xassert (matrix->pool->glyphs); | |
| 677 | |
| 678 if (w) | |
| 679 { | |
| 680 left = margin_glyphs_to_reserve (w, dim.width, | |
| 681 w->left_margin_width); | |
| 682 right = margin_glyphs_to_reserve (w, dim.width, | |
| 683 w->right_margin_width); | |
| 684 } | |
| 685 else | |
| 686 left = right = 0; | |
| 687 | |
| 688 for (i = 0; i < dim.height; ++i) | |
| 689 { | |
| 690 struct glyph_row *row = &matrix->rows[i]; | |
| 691 | |
| 692 row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] | |
| 693 = (matrix->pool->glyphs | |
| 694 + (y + i) * matrix->pool->ncolumns | |
| 695 + x); | |
| 696 | |
| 697 if (w == NULL | |
| 698 || row == matrix->rows + dim.height - 1 | |
| 25546 | 699 || (row == matrix->rows && matrix->header_line_p)) |
| 25012 | 700 { |
| 701 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] | |
| 702 = row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA]; | |
| 703 row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] | |
| 704 = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + dim.width; | |
| 705 row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] | |
| 706 = row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA]; | |
| 707 } | |
| 708 else | |
| 709 { | |
| 710 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] | |
| 711 = row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] + left; | |
| 712 row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] | |
| 713 = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + dim.width - left - right; | |
| 714 row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] | |
| 715 = row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] + dim.width; | |
| 716 } | |
| 717 } | |
| 718 | |
| 719 matrix->left_margin_glyphs = left; | |
| 720 matrix->right_margin_glyphs = right; | |
| 721 } | |
| 722 else | |
| 723 { | |
| 724 /* If MATRIX->pool is null, MATRIX is responsible for managing | |
| 725 its own memory. Allocate glyph memory from the heap. */ | |
| 726 if (dim.width > matrix->matrix_w | |
| 727 || new_rows | |
| 25546 | 728 || header_line_changed_p |
| 25012 | 729 || marginal_areas_changed_p) |
| 730 { | |
| 731 struct glyph_row *row = matrix->rows; | |
| 732 struct glyph_row *end = row + matrix->rows_allocated; | |
| 733 | |
| 734 while (row < end) | |
| 735 { | |
| 736 row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] | |
| 737 = (struct glyph *) xrealloc (row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA], | |
| 738 (dim.width | |
| 739 * sizeof (struct glyph))); | |
| 740 | |
| 741 /* The mode line never has marginal areas. */ | |
| 742 if (row == matrix->rows + dim.height - 1 | |
| 25546 | 743 || (row == matrix->rows && matrix->header_line_p)) |
| 25012 | 744 { |
| 745 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] | |
| 746 = row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA]; | |
| 747 row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] | |
| 748 = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + dim.width; | |
| 749 row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] | |
| 750 = row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA]; | |
| 751 } | |
| 752 else | |
| 753 { | |
| 754 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] | |
| 755 = row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] + left; | |
| 756 row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] | |
| 757 = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + dim.width - left - right; | |
| 758 row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] | |
| 759 = row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] + dim.width; | |
| 760 } | |
| 761 ++row; | |
| 762 } | |
| 763 } | |
| 764 | |
| 765 xassert (left >= 0 && right >= 0); | |
| 766 matrix->left_margin_glyphs = left; | |
| 767 matrix->right_margin_glyphs = right; | |
| 768 } | |
| 769 | |
| 770 /* Number of rows to be used by MATRIX. */ | |
| 771 matrix->nrows = dim.height; | |
|
31932
081edde76197
(adjust_glyph_matrix, enable_glyph_matrix_rows):
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31850
diff
changeset
|
772 xassert (matrix->nrows >= 0); |
| 25012 | 773 |
|
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
774 if (w) |
| 25012 | 775 { |
|
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
776 if (matrix == w->current_matrix) |
| 25012 | 777 { |
|
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
778 /* Mark rows in a current matrix of a window as not having |
|
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
779 valid contents. It's important to not do this for |
|
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
780 desired matrices. When Emacs starts, it may already be |
|
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
781 building desired matrices when this function runs. */ |
|
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
782 if (window_width < 0) |
|
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
783 window_width = window_box_width (w, -1); |
|
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
784 |
|
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
785 /* Optimize the case that only the height has changed (C-x 2, |
|
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
786 upper window). Invalidate all rows that are no longer part |
|
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
787 of the window. */ |
|
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
788 if (!marginal_areas_changed_p |
|
37098
e293840c7332
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Don't try to reuse the current
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36697
diff
changeset
|
789 && !header_line_changed_p |
|
e293840c7332
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Don't try to reuse the current
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36697
diff
changeset
|
790 && new_rows == 0 |
|
e293840c7332
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Don't try to reuse the current
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36697
diff
changeset
|
791 && dim.width == matrix->matrix_w |
|
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
792 && matrix->window_left_x == XFASTINT (w->left) |
|
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
793 && matrix->window_top_y == XFASTINT (w->top) |
|
37098
e293840c7332
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Don't try to reuse the current
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36697
diff
changeset
|
794 && matrix->window_width == window_width) |
|
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
795 { |
|
38528
c867615c6a26
(adjust_glyph_matrix): In the optimization for
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38489
diff
changeset
|
796 /* Find the last row in the window. */ |
|
c867615c6a26
(adjust_glyph_matrix): In the optimization for
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38489
diff
changeset
|
797 for (i = 0; i < matrix->nrows && matrix->rows[i].enabled_p; ++i) |
|
c867615c6a26
(adjust_glyph_matrix): In the optimization for
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38489
diff
changeset
|
798 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (matrix->rows + i) >= window_height) |
|
c867615c6a26
(adjust_glyph_matrix): In the optimization for
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38489
diff
changeset
|
799 { |
|
38748
bb32ae33769e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Undo last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38734
diff
changeset
|
800 ++i; |
|
38528
c867615c6a26
(adjust_glyph_matrix): In the optimization for
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38489
diff
changeset
|
801 break; |
|
c867615c6a26
(adjust_glyph_matrix): In the optimization for
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38489
diff
changeset
|
802 } |
|
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
803 |
|
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
804 /* Window end is invalid, if inside of the rows that |
|
38528
c867615c6a26
(adjust_glyph_matrix): In the optimization for
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38489
diff
changeset
|
805 are invalidated below. */ |
|
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
806 if (INTEGERP (w->window_end_vpos) |
|
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
807 && XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) >= i) |
|
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
808 w->window_end_valid = Qnil; |
| 25012 | 809 |
|
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
810 while (i < matrix->nrows) |
|
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
811 matrix->rows[i++].enabled_p = 0; |
|
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
812 } |
|
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
813 else |
|
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
814 { |
|
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
815 for (i = 0; i < matrix->nrows; ++i) |
|
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
816 matrix->rows[i].enabled_p = 0; |
|
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
817 } |
| 25012 | 818 } |
|
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
819 else if (matrix == w->desired_matrix) |
| 25012 | 820 { |
|
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
821 /* Rows in desired matrices always have to be cleared; |
|
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
822 redisplay expects this is the case when it runs, so it |
|
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
823 had better be the case when we adjust matrices between |
|
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
824 redisplays. */ |
| 25012 | 825 for (i = 0; i < matrix->nrows; ++i) |
| 826 matrix->rows[i].enabled_p = 0; | |
| 827 } | |
| 828 } | |
|
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
829 |
| 25012 | 830 |
| 831 /* Remember last values to be able to optimize frame redraws. */ | |
| 832 matrix->matrix_x = x; | |
| 833 matrix->matrix_y = y; | |
| 834 matrix->matrix_w = dim.width; | |
| 835 matrix->matrix_h = dim.height; | |
| 836 | |
| 837 /* Record the top y location and height of W at the time the matrix | |
| 838 was last adjusted. This is used to optimize redisplay above. */ | |
| 839 if (w) | |
| 840 { | |
|
34279
7ab25b4a077c
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Don't reuse a window's current
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34203
diff
changeset
|
841 matrix->window_left_x = XFASTINT (w->left); |
| 25012 | 842 matrix->window_top_y = XFASTINT (w->top); |
| 843 matrix->window_height = window_height; | |
| 844 matrix->window_width = window_width; | |
| 845 matrix->window_vscroll = w->vscroll; | |
| 846 } | |
| 847 } | |
| 848 | |
| 849 | |
| 850 /* Reverse the contents of rows in MATRIX between START and END. The | |
| 851 contents of the row at END - 1 end up at START, END - 2 at START + | |
| 852 1 etc. This is part of the implementation of rotate_matrix (see | |
| 853 below). */ | |
| 314 | 854 |
| 855 static void | |
| 25012 | 856 reverse_rows (matrix, start, end) |
| 857 struct glyph_matrix *matrix; | |
| 858 int start, end; | |
| 314 | 859 { |
| 25012 | 860 int i, j; |
| 861 | |
| 862 for (i = start, j = end - 1; i < j; ++i, --j) | |
| 863 { | |
| 864 /* Non-ISO HP/UX compiler doesn't like auto struct | |
| 865 initialization. */ | |
| 866 struct glyph_row temp; | |
| 867 temp = matrix->rows[i]; | |
| 868 matrix->rows[i] = matrix->rows[j]; | |
| 869 matrix->rows[j] = temp; | |
| 870 } | |
| 314 | 871 } |
| 872 | |
| 25012 | 873 |
| 874 /* Rotate the contents of rows in MATRIX in the range FIRST .. LAST - | |
| 875 1 by BY positions. BY < 0 means rotate left, i.e. towards lower | |
| 876 indices. (Note: this does not copy glyphs, only glyph pointers in | |
| 877 row structures are moved around). | |
| 878 | |
| 879 The algorithm used for rotating the vector was, I believe, first | |
| 880 described by Kernighan. See the vector R as consisting of two | |
| 881 sub-vectors AB, where A has length BY for BY >= 0. The result | |
| 882 after rotating is then BA. Reverse both sub-vectors to get ArBr | |
| 883 and reverse the result to get (ArBr)r which is BA. Similar for | |
| 884 rotating right. */ | |
| 885 | |
| 886 void | |
| 887 rotate_matrix (matrix, first, last, by) | |
| 888 struct glyph_matrix *matrix; | |
| 889 int first, last, by; | |
| 314 | 890 { |
| 25012 | 891 if (by < 0) |
| 892 { | |
| 893 /* Up (rotate left, i.e. towards lower indices). */ | |
| 894 by = -by; | |
| 895 reverse_rows (matrix, first, first + by); | |
| 896 reverse_rows (matrix, first + by, last); | |
| 897 reverse_rows (matrix, first, last); | |
| 898 } | |
| 899 else if (by > 0) | |
| 314 | 900 { |
| 25012 | 901 /* Down (rotate right, i.e. towards higher indices). */ |
| 902 reverse_rows (matrix, last - by, last); | |
| 903 reverse_rows (matrix, first, last - by); | |
| 904 reverse_rows (matrix, first, last); | |
| 314 | 905 } |
| 25012 | 906 } |
| 907 | |
| 908 | |
| 909 /* Increment buffer positions in glyph rows of MATRIX. Do it for rows | |
| 910 with indices START <= index < END. Increment positions by DELTA/ | |
| 911 DELTA_BYTES. */ | |
| 912 | |
| 913 void | |
|
28708
4e2497e6757e
(increment_matrix_positions): Renamed from
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28682
diff
changeset
|
914 increment_matrix_positions (matrix, start, end, delta, delta_bytes) |
| 25012 | 915 struct glyph_matrix *matrix; |
| 916 int start, end, delta, delta_bytes; | |
| 917 { | |
| 918 /* Check that START and END are reasonable values. */ | |
| 919 xassert (start >= 0 && start <= matrix->nrows); | |
| 920 xassert (end >= 0 && end <= matrix->nrows); | |
| 921 xassert (start <= end); | |
| 922 | |
| 923 for (; start < end; ++start) | |
|
28708
4e2497e6757e
(increment_matrix_positions): Renamed from
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28682
diff
changeset
|
924 increment_row_positions (matrix->rows + start, delta, delta_bytes); |
| 25012 | 925 } |
| 926 | |
| 927 | |
| 928 /* Enable a range of rows in glyph matrix MATRIX. START and END are | |
| 929 the row indices of the first and last + 1 row to enable. If | |
| 930 ENABLED_P is non-zero, enabled_p flags in rows will be set to 1. */ | |
| 931 | |
| 932 void | |
| 933 enable_glyph_matrix_rows (matrix, start, end, enabled_p) | |
| 934 struct glyph_matrix *matrix; | |
| 935 int start, end; | |
| 936 int enabled_p; | |
| 937 { | |
|
31932
081edde76197
(adjust_glyph_matrix, enable_glyph_matrix_rows):
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31850
diff
changeset
|
938 xassert (start <= end); |
|
081edde76197
(adjust_glyph_matrix, enable_glyph_matrix_rows):
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31850
diff
changeset
|
939 xassert (start >= 0 && start < matrix->nrows); |
|
081edde76197
(adjust_glyph_matrix, enable_glyph_matrix_rows):
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31850
diff
changeset
|
940 xassert (end >= 0 && end <= matrix->nrows); |
|
081edde76197
(adjust_glyph_matrix, enable_glyph_matrix_rows):
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31850
diff
changeset
|
941 |
| 25012 | 942 for (; start < end; ++start) |
| 943 matrix->rows[start].enabled_p = enabled_p != 0; | |
| 944 } | |
| 945 | |
| 946 | |
| 947 /* Clear MATRIX. | |
| 948 | |
| 949 This empties all rows in MATRIX by setting the enabled_p flag for | |
| 950 all rows of the matrix to zero. The function prepare_desired_row | |
| 951 will eventually really clear a row when it sees one with a zero | |
| 952 enabled_p flag. | |
| 953 | |
| 954 Resets update hints to defaults value. The only update hint | |
| 955 currently present is the flag MATRIX->no_scrolling_p. */ | |
| 956 | |
| 957 void | |
| 958 clear_glyph_matrix (matrix) | |
| 959 struct glyph_matrix *matrix; | |
| 960 { | |
| 961 if (matrix) | |
| 314 | 962 { |
| 25012 | 963 enable_glyph_matrix_rows (matrix, 0, matrix->nrows, 0); |
| 964 matrix->no_scrolling_p = 0; | |
| 314 | 965 } |
| 966 } | |
| 25012 | 967 |
| 968 | |
| 969 /* Shift part of the glyph matrix MATRIX of window W up or down. | |
| 970 Increment y-positions in glyph rows between START and END by DY, | |
| 971 and recompute their visible height. */ | |
| 972 | |
| 973 void | |
| 974 shift_glyph_matrix (w, matrix, start, end, dy) | |
| 975 struct window *w; | |
| 976 struct glyph_matrix *matrix; | |
| 977 int start, end, dy; | |
| 978 { | |
| 979 int min_y, max_y; | |
| 980 | |
| 981 xassert (start <= end); | |
| 982 xassert (start >= 0 && start < matrix->nrows); | |
| 983 xassert (end >= 0 && end <= matrix->nrows); | |
| 984 | |
| 25546 | 985 min_y = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w); |
| 25012 | 986 max_y = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEIGHT_NO_MODE_LINE (w); |
| 987 | |
| 988 for (; start < end; ++start) | |
| 989 { | |
| 990 struct glyph_row *row = &matrix->rows[start]; | |
| 991 | |
| 992 row->y += dy; | |
|
38587
42e75caf68ff
(shift_glyph_matrix, blank_row): Fix computation
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38528
diff
changeset
|
993 row->visible_height = row->height; |
| 25012 | 994 |
| 995 if (row->y < min_y) | |
|
38587
42e75caf68ff
(shift_glyph_matrix, blank_row): Fix computation
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38528
diff
changeset
|
996 row->visible_height -= min_y - row->y; |
|
42e75caf68ff
(shift_glyph_matrix, blank_row): Fix computation
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38528
diff
changeset
|
997 if (row->y + row->height > max_y) |
|
42e75caf68ff
(shift_glyph_matrix, blank_row): Fix computation
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38528
diff
changeset
|
998 row->visible_height -= row->y + row->height - max_y; |
| 25012 | 999 } |
| 1000 } | |
| 1001 | |
| 1002 | |
| 1003 /* Mark all rows in current matrices of frame F as invalid. Marking | |
| 1004 invalid is done by setting enabled_p to zero for all rows in a | |
| 1005 current matrix. */ | |
| 1006 | |
| 1007 void | |
| 1008 clear_current_matrices (f) | |
| 1009 register struct frame *f; | |
| 1010 { | |
| 1011 /* Clear frame current matrix, if we have one. */ | |
| 1012 if (f->current_matrix) | |
| 1013 clear_glyph_matrix (f->current_matrix); | |
| 1014 | |
| 1015 /* Clear the matrix of the menu bar window, if such a window exists. | |
| 1016 The menu bar window is currently used to display menus on X when | |
| 1017 no toolkit support is compiled in. */ | |
| 1018 if (WINDOWP (f->menu_bar_window)) | |
| 1019 clear_glyph_matrix (XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window)->current_matrix); | |
| 1020 | |
|
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
1021 /* Clear the matrix of the tool-bar window, if any. */ |
|
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
1022 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)) |
|
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
1023 clear_glyph_matrix (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)->current_matrix); |
| 25012 | 1024 |
| 1025 /* Clear current window matrices. */ | |
| 1026 xassert (WINDOWP (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f))); | |
| 1027 clear_window_matrices (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)), 0); | |
| 1028 } | |
| 1029 | |
| 1030 | |
| 1031 /* Clear out all display lines of F for a coming redisplay. */ | |
| 314 | 1032 |
| 21514 | 1033 void |
| 25012 | 1034 clear_desired_matrices (f) |
| 1035 register struct frame *f; | |
| 314 | 1036 { |
| 25012 | 1037 if (f->desired_matrix) |
| 1038 clear_glyph_matrix (f->desired_matrix); | |
| 1039 | |
| 1040 if (WINDOWP (f->menu_bar_window)) | |
| 1041 clear_glyph_matrix (XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window)->desired_matrix); | |
| 1042 | |
|
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
1043 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)) |
|
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
1044 clear_glyph_matrix (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)->desired_matrix); |
| 25012 | 1045 |
| 1046 /* Do it for window matrices. */ | |
| 1047 xassert (WINDOWP (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f))); | |
| 1048 clear_window_matrices (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)), 1); | |
| 1049 } | |
| 1050 | |
| 1051 | |
| 1052 /* Clear matrices in window tree rooted in W. If DESIRED_P is | |
| 1053 non-zero clear desired matrices, otherwise clear current matrices. */ | |
| 1054 | |
| 1055 static void | |
| 1056 clear_window_matrices (w, desired_p) | |
| 1057 struct window *w; | |
| 1058 int desired_p; | |
| 1059 { | |
| 1060 while (w) | |
| 314 | 1061 { |
| 25012 | 1062 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) |
| 1063 { | |
| 1064 xassert (WINDOWP (w->hchild)); | |
| 1065 clear_window_matrices (XWINDOW (w->hchild), desired_p); | |
| 1066 } | |
| 1067 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) | |
| 314 | 1068 { |
| 25012 | 1069 xassert (WINDOWP (w->vchild)); |
| 1070 clear_window_matrices (XWINDOW (w->vchild), desired_p); | |
| 1071 } | |
| 1072 else | |
| 1073 { | |
| 1074 if (desired_p) | |
| 1075 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix); | |
| 1076 else | |
| 314 | 1077 { |
| 25012 | 1078 clear_glyph_matrix (w->current_matrix); |
| 1079 w->window_end_valid = Qnil; | |
| 314 | 1080 } |
| 25012 | 1081 } |
| 1082 | |
| 1083 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); | |
| 1084 } | |
| 1085 } | |
| 1086 | |
| 1087 | |
| 1088 | |
| 1089 /*********************************************************************** | |
| 1090 Glyph Rows | |
| 1091 | |
| 1092 See dispextern.h for an overall explanation of glyph rows. | |
| 1093 ***********************************************************************/ | |
| 1094 | |
| 1095 /* Clear glyph row ROW. Do it in a way that makes it robust against | |
| 1096 changes in the glyph_row structure, i.e. addition or removal of | |
| 1097 structure members. */ | |
| 1098 | |
|
33527
c4c7abc48752
(null_row): New gloval static variable.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
33101
diff
changeset
|
1099 static struct glyph_row null_row; |
|
c4c7abc48752
(null_row): New gloval static variable.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
33101
diff
changeset
|
1100 |
| 25012 | 1101 void |
| 1102 clear_glyph_row (row) | |
| 1103 struct glyph_row *row; | |
| 1104 { | |
| 1105 struct glyph *p[1 + LAST_AREA]; | |
| 1106 | |
| 1107 /* Save pointers. */ | |
| 1108 p[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] = row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA]; | |
| 1109 p[TEXT_AREA] = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; | |
| 1110 p[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] = row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA]; | |
| 1111 p[LAST_AREA] = row->glyphs[LAST_AREA]; | |
| 1112 | |
| 1113 /* Clear. */ | |
| 1114 *row = null_row; | |
| 1115 | |
| 1116 /* Restore pointers. */ | |
| 1117 row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] = p[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA]; | |
| 1118 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] = p[TEXT_AREA]; | |
| 1119 row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] = p[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA]; | |
| 1120 row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] = p[LAST_AREA]; | |
|
30041
b20d72b7aa4b
(clear_glyph_row): Add debug code in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29980
diff
changeset
|
1121 |
|
b20d72b7aa4b
(clear_glyph_row): Add debug code in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29980
diff
changeset
|
1122 #if 0 /* At some point, some bit-fields of struct glyph were not set, |
|
b20d72b7aa4b
(clear_glyph_row): Add debug code in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29980
diff
changeset
|
1123 which made glyphs unequal when compared with GLYPH_EQUAL_P. |
|
b20d72b7aa4b
(clear_glyph_row): Add debug code in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29980
diff
changeset
|
1124 Redisplay outputs such glyphs, and flickering effects were |
|
b20d72b7aa4b
(clear_glyph_row): Add debug code in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29980
diff
changeset
|
1125 the result. This also depended on the contents of memory |
|
b20d72b7aa4b
(clear_glyph_row): Add debug code in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29980
diff
changeset
|
1126 returned by xmalloc. If flickering happens again, activate |
|
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
1127 the code below. If the flickering is gone with that, chances |
|
30041
b20d72b7aa4b
(clear_glyph_row): Add debug code in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29980
diff
changeset
|
1128 are that the flickering has the same reason as here. */ |
|
b20d72b7aa4b
(clear_glyph_row): Add debug code in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29980
diff
changeset
|
1129 bzero (p[0], (char *) p[LAST_AREA] - (char *) p[0]); |
|
b20d72b7aa4b
(clear_glyph_row): Add debug code in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29980
diff
changeset
|
1130 #endif |
| 25012 | 1131 } |
| 1132 | |
| 1133 | |
| 1134 /* Make ROW an empty, enabled row of canonical character height, | |
| 1135 in window W starting at y-position Y. */ | |
| 1136 | |
| 1137 void | |
| 1138 blank_row (w, row, y) | |
| 1139 struct window *w; | |
| 1140 struct glyph_row *row; | |
| 1141 int y; | |
| 1142 { | |
| 1143 int min_y, max_y; | |
| 1144 | |
| 25546 | 1145 min_y = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w); |
| 25012 | 1146 max_y = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEIGHT_NO_MODE_LINE (w); |
| 1147 | |
| 1148 clear_glyph_row (row); | |
| 1149 row->y = y; | |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
1150 row->ascent = row->phys_ascent = 0; |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
1151 row->height = row->phys_height = CANON_Y_UNIT (XFRAME (w->frame)); |
|
38587
42e75caf68ff
(shift_glyph_matrix, blank_row): Fix computation
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38528
diff
changeset
|
1152 row->visible_height = row->height; |
|
42e75caf68ff
(shift_glyph_matrix, blank_row): Fix computation
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38528
diff
changeset
|
1153 |
| 25012 | 1154 if (row->y < min_y) |
|
38587
42e75caf68ff
(shift_glyph_matrix, blank_row): Fix computation
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38528
diff
changeset
|
1155 row->visible_height -= min_y - row->y; |
|
42e75caf68ff
(shift_glyph_matrix, blank_row): Fix computation
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38528
diff
changeset
|
1156 if (row->y + row->height > max_y) |
|
42e75caf68ff
(shift_glyph_matrix, blank_row): Fix computation
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38528
diff
changeset
|
1157 row->visible_height -= row->y + row->height - max_y; |
| 25012 | 1158 |
| 1159 row->enabled_p = 1; | |
| 1160 } | |
| 1161 | |
| 1162 | |
| 1163 /* Increment buffer positions in glyph row ROW. DELTA and DELTA_BYTES | |
| 1164 are the amounts by which to change positions. Note that the first | |
| 1165 glyph of the text area of a row can have a buffer position even if | |
| 1166 the used count of the text area is zero. Such rows display line | |
| 1167 ends. */ | |
| 1168 | |
| 1169 void | |
|
28708
4e2497e6757e
(increment_matrix_positions): Renamed from
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28682
diff
changeset
|
1170 increment_row_positions (row, delta, delta_bytes) |
| 25012 | 1171 struct glyph_row *row; |
| 1172 int delta, delta_bytes; | |
| 1173 { | |
| 1174 int area, i; | |
| 1175 | |
| 1176 /* Increment start and end positions. */ | |
| 1177 MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) += delta; | |
| 1178 MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row) += delta_bytes; | |
| 1179 MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) += delta; | |
| 1180 MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) += delta_bytes; | |
| 1181 | |
| 1182 /* Increment positions in glyphs. */ | |
| 1183 for (area = 0; area < LAST_AREA; ++area) | |
| 1184 for (i = 0; i < row->used[area]; ++i) | |
| 1185 if (BUFFERP (row->glyphs[area][i].object) | |
| 1186 && row->glyphs[area][i].charpos > 0) | |
| 1187 row->glyphs[area][i].charpos += delta; | |
| 1188 | |
| 1189 /* Capture the case of rows displaying a line end. */ | |
| 1190 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA] == 0 | |
| 1191 && MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)) | |
| 1192 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->charpos += delta; | |
| 1193 } | |
| 1194 | |
| 1195 | |
|
29336
5ccfe8a1638f
(find_glyph_row_slice, swap_glyphs_in_rows): Put in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28708
diff
changeset
|
1196 #if 0 |
| 25012 | 1197 /* Swap glyphs between two glyph rows A and B. This exchanges glyph |
| 1198 contents, i.e. glyph structure contents are exchanged between A and | |
| 1199 B without changing glyph pointers in A and B. */ | |
| 1200 | |
| 1201 static void | |
| 1202 swap_glyphs_in_rows (a, b) | |
| 1203 struct glyph_row *a, *b; | |
| 1204 { | |
| 1205 int area; | |
| 1206 | |
| 1207 for (area = 0; area < LAST_AREA; ++area) | |
| 1208 { | |
| 1209 /* Number of glyphs to swap. */ | |
| 1210 int max_used = max (a->used[area], b->used[area]); | |
| 1211 | |
| 1212 /* Start of glyphs in area of row A. */ | |
| 1213 struct glyph *glyph_a = a->glyphs[area]; | |
| 1214 | |
| 1215 /* End + 1 of glyphs in area of row A. */ | |
| 1216 struct glyph *glyph_a_end = a->glyphs[max_used]; | |
| 1217 | |
| 1218 /* Start of glyphs in area of row B. */ | |
| 1219 struct glyph *glyph_b = b->glyphs[area]; | |
| 1220 | |
| 1221 while (glyph_a < glyph_a_end) | |
| 1222 { | |
| 1223 /* Non-ISO HP/UX compiler doesn't like auto struct | |
| 1224 initialization. */ | |
| 1225 struct glyph temp; | |
| 1226 temp = *glyph_a; | |
| 1227 *glyph_a = *glyph_b; | |
| 1228 *glyph_b = temp; | |
| 1229 ++glyph_a; | |
| 1230 ++glyph_b; | |
| 314 | 1231 } |
| 1232 } | |
| 1233 } | |
| 25012 | 1234 |
|
29336
5ccfe8a1638f
(find_glyph_row_slice, swap_glyphs_in_rows): Put in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28708
diff
changeset
|
1235 #endif /* 0 */ |
| 25012 | 1236 |
| 1237 /* Exchange pointers to glyph memory between glyph rows A and B. */ | |
| 1238 | |
| 1239 static INLINE void | |
| 1240 swap_glyph_pointers (a, b) | |
| 1241 struct glyph_row *a, *b; | |
| 1242 { | |
| 1243 int i; | |
| 1244 for (i = 0; i < LAST_AREA + 1; ++i) | |
| 1245 { | |
| 1246 struct glyph *temp = a->glyphs[i]; | |
| 1247 a->glyphs[i] = b->glyphs[i]; | |
| 1248 b->glyphs[i] = temp; | |
| 1249 } | |
| 1250 } | |
| 1251 | |
| 1252 | |
| 1253 /* Copy glyph row structure FROM to glyph row structure TO, except | |
| 1254 that glyph pointers in the structures are left unchanged. */ | |
| 1255 | |
| 1256 INLINE void | |
| 1257 copy_row_except_pointers (to, from) | |
| 1258 struct glyph_row *to, *from; | |
| 1259 { | |
| 1260 struct glyph *pointers[1 + LAST_AREA]; | |
| 1261 | |
| 1262 /* Save glyph pointers of TO. */ | |
| 1263 bcopy (to->glyphs, pointers, sizeof to->glyphs); | |
| 1264 | |
| 1265 /* Do a structure assignment. */ | |
| 1266 *to = *from; | |
| 1267 | |
| 1268 /* Restore original pointers of TO. */ | |
| 1269 bcopy (pointers, to->glyphs, sizeof to->glyphs); | |
| 1270 } | |
| 1271 | |
| 1272 | |
| 1273 /* Copy contents of glyph row FROM to glyph row TO. Glyph pointers in | |
| 1274 TO and FROM are left unchanged. Glyph contents are copied from the | |
| 1275 glyph memory of FROM to the glyph memory of TO. Increment buffer | |
| 1276 positions in row TO by DELTA/ DELTA_BYTES. */ | |
| 1277 | |
| 1278 void | |
| 1279 copy_glyph_row_contents (to, from, delta, delta_bytes) | |
| 1280 struct glyph_row *to, *from; | |
| 1281 int delta, delta_bytes; | |
| 1282 { | |
| 1283 int area; | |
| 1284 | |
| 1285 /* This is like a structure assignment TO = FROM, except that | |
| 1286 glyph pointers in the rows are left unchanged. */ | |
| 1287 copy_row_except_pointers (to, from); | |
| 1288 | |
| 1289 /* Copy glyphs from FROM to TO. */ | |
| 1290 for (area = 0; area < LAST_AREA; ++area) | |
| 1291 if (from->used[area]) | |
| 1292 bcopy (from->glyphs[area], to->glyphs[area], | |
| 1293 from->used[area] * sizeof (struct glyph)); | |
| 1294 | |
| 1295 /* Increment buffer positions in TO by DELTA. */ | |
|
28708
4e2497e6757e
(increment_matrix_positions): Renamed from
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28682
diff
changeset
|
1296 increment_row_positions (to, delta, delta_bytes); |
| 25012 | 1297 } |
| 1298 | |
| 1299 | |
| 1300 /* Assign glyph row FROM to glyph row TO. This works like a structure | |
| 1301 assignment TO = FROM, except that glyph pointers are not copied but | |
| 1302 exchanged between TO and FROM. Pointers must be exchanged to avoid | |
| 1303 a memory leak. */ | |
| 1304 | |
| 1305 static INLINE void | |
| 1306 assign_row (to, from) | |
| 1307 struct glyph_row *to, *from; | |
| 1308 { | |
| 1309 swap_glyph_pointers (to, from); | |
| 1310 copy_row_except_pointers (to, from); | |
| 1311 } | |
| 1312 | |
| 1313 | |
| 1314 /* Test whether the glyph memory of the glyph row WINDOW_ROW, which is | |
| 1315 a row in a window matrix, is a slice of the glyph memory of the | |
| 1316 glyph row FRAME_ROW which is a row in a frame glyph matrix. Value | |
| 1317 is non-zero if the glyph memory of WINDOW_ROW is part of the glyph | |
| 1318 memory of FRAME_ROW. */ | |
| 1319 | |
|
34893
779bd3fa820e
Use #if GLYPH_DEBUG instead of #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34866
diff
changeset
|
1320 #if GLYPH_DEBUG |
|
30323
4cd1b8fe118c
(direct_output_for_insert): Remove confusing
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30307
diff
changeset
|
1321 |
| 25012 | 1322 static int |
| 1323 glyph_row_slice_p (window_row, frame_row) | |
| 1324 struct glyph_row *window_row, *frame_row; | |
| 1325 { | |
| 1326 struct glyph *window_glyph_start = window_row->glyphs[0]; | |
| 1327 struct glyph *frame_glyph_start = frame_row->glyphs[0]; | |
| 1328 struct glyph *frame_glyph_end = frame_row->glyphs[LAST_AREA]; | |
| 1329 | |
| 1330 return (frame_glyph_start <= window_glyph_start | |
| 1331 && window_glyph_start < frame_glyph_end); | |
| 1332 } | |
| 1333 | |
|
30323
4cd1b8fe118c
(direct_output_for_insert): Remove confusing
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30307
diff
changeset
|
1334 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */ |
| 25012 | 1335 |
|
29336
5ccfe8a1638f
(find_glyph_row_slice, swap_glyphs_in_rows): Put in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28708
diff
changeset
|
1336 #if 0 |
|
5ccfe8a1638f
(find_glyph_row_slice, swap_glyphs_in_rows): Put in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28708
diff
changeset
|
1337 |
| 25012 | 1338 /* Find the row in the window glyph matrix WINDOW_MATRIX being a slice |
| 1339 of ROW in the frame matrix FRAME_MATRIX. Value is null if no row | |
| 1340 in WINDOW_MATRIX is found satisfying the condition. */ | |
| 1341 | |
| 1342 static struct glyph_row * | |
| 1343 find_glyph_row_slice (window_matrix, frame_matrix, row) | |
| 1344 struct glyph_matrix *window_matrix, *frame_matrix; | |
| 1345 int row; | |
| 1346 { | |
| 1347 int i; | |
| 1348 | |
| 1349 xassert (row >= 0 && row < frame_matrix->nrows); | |
| 1350 | |
| 1351 for (i = 0; i < window_matrix->nrows; ++i) | |
| 1352 if (glyph_row_slice_p (window_matrix->rows + i, | |
| 1353 frame_matrix->rows + row)) | |
| 1354 break; | |
| 1355 | |
| 1356 return i < window_matrix->nrows ? window_matrix->rows + i : 0; | |
| 1357 } | |
| 1358 | |
|
29336
5ccfe8a1638f
(find_glyph_row_slice, swap_glyphs_in_rows): Put in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28708
diff
changeset
|
1359 #endif /* 0 */ |
| 25012 | 1360 |
| 1361 /* Prepare ROW for display. Desired rows are cleared lazily, | |
| 1362 i.e. they are only marked as to be cleared by setting their | |
| 1363 enabled_p flag to zero. When a row is to be displayed, a prior | |
| 1364 call to this function really clears it. */ | |
| 1365 | |
| 1366 void | |
| 1367 prepare_desired_row (row) | |
| 1368 struct glyph_row *row; | |
| 1369 { | |
| 1370 if (!row->enabled_p) | |
| 1371 { | |
| 1372 clear_glyph_row (row); | |
| 1373 row->enabled_p = 1; | |
| 1374 } | |
| 1375 } | |
| 1376 | |
| 1377 | |
| 1378 /* Return a hash code for glyph row ROW. */ | |
| 1379 | |
| 1380 int | |
| 1381 line_hash_code (row) | |
| 1382 struct glyph_row *row; | |
| 1383 { | |
| 1384 int hash = 0; | |
| 1385 | |
| 1386 if (row->enabled_p) | |
| 1387 { | |
|
40075
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1388 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; |
|
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1389 struct glyph *end = glyph + row->used[TEXT_AREA]; |
|
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1390 |
|
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1391 while (glyph < end) |
|
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1392 { |
|
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1393 int c = glyph->u.ch; |
|
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1394 int face_id = glyph->face_id; |
|
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1395 if (must_write_spaces) |
|
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1396 c -= SPACEGLYPH; |
|
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1397 hash = (((hash << 4) + (hash >> 24)) & 0x0fffffff) + c; |
|
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1398 hash = (((hash << 4) + (hash >> 24)) & 0x0fffffff) + face_id; |
|
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1399 ++glyph; |
|
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1400 } |
|
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1401 |
|
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1402 if (hash == 0) |
|
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1403 hash = 1; |
| 25012 | 1404 } |
| 1405 | |
| 1406 return hash; | |
| 1407 } | |
| 1408 | |
| 1409 | |
|
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
1410 /* Return the cost of drawing line VPOS in MATRIX. The cost equals |
| 25012 | 1411 the number of characters in the line. If must_write_spaces is |
| 1412 zero, leading and trailing spaces are ignored. */ | |
| 1413 | |
| 1414 static unsigned int | |
| 1415 line_draw_cost (matrix, vpos) | |
| 1416 struct glyph_matrix *matrix; | |
| 1417 int vpos; | |
| 1418 { | |
| 1419 struct glyph_row *row = matrix->rows + vpos; | |
| 1420 struct glyph *beg = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; | |
| 1421 struct glyph *end = beg + row->used[TEXT_AREA]; | |
| 1422 int len; | |
| 1423 Lisp_Object *glyph_table_base = GLYPH_TABLE_BASE; | |
| 1424 int glyph_table_len = GLYPH_TABLE_LENGTH; | |
| 1425 | |
| 1426 /* Ignore trailing and leading spaces if we can. */ | |
| 1427 if (!must_write_spaces) | |
| 1428 { | |
| 1429 /* Skip from the end over trailing spaces. */ | |
|
34203
e55480843a8e
(scrolling_window): Fix code inserting runs in list of all runs.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33763
diff
changeset
|
1430 while (end > beg && CHAR_GLYPH_SPACE_P (*(end - 1))) |
| 25012 | 1431 --end; |
| 1432 | |
| 1433 /* All blank line. */ | |
| 1434 if (end == beg) | |
| 1435 return 0; | |
| 1436 | |
| 1437 /* Skip over leading spaces. */ | |
| 1438 while (CHAR_GLYPH_SPACE_P (*beg)) | |
| 1439 ++beg; | |
| 1440 } | |
| 1441 | |
| 1442 /* If we don't have a glyph-table, each glyph is one character, | |
| 1443 so return the number of glyphs. */ | |
| 1444 if (glyph_table_base == 0) | |
| 1445 len = end - beg; | |
| 1446 else | |
| 1447 { | |
| 1448 /* Otherwise, scan the glyphs and accumulate their total length | |
| 1449 in LEN. */ | |
| 1450 len = 0; | |
| 1451 while (beg < end) | |
| 1452 { | |
| 1453 GLYPH g = GLYPH_FROM_CHAR_GLYPH (*beg); | |
| 1454 | |
|
26998
02e902f732d1
(line_hash_code) (direct_output_for_insert): Adjusted
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
26902
diff
changeset
|
1455 if (g < 0 |
|
02e902f732d1
(line_hash_code) (direct_output_for_insert): Adjusted
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
26902
diff
changeset
|
1456 || GLYPH_SIMPLE_P (glyph_table_base, glyph_table_len, g)) |
| 25012 | 1457 len += 1; |
| 1458 else | |
| 1459 len += GLYPH_LENGTH (glyph_table_base, g); | |
| 1460 | |
| 1461 ++beg; | |
| 1462 } | |
| 1463 } | |
| 1464 | |
| 1465 return len; | |
| 1466 } | |
| 1467 | |
| 1468 | |
| 1469 /* Test two glyph rows A and B for equality. Value is non-zero if A | |
| 1470 and B have equal contents. W is the window to which the glyphs | |
| 1471 rows A and B belong. It is needed here to test for partial row | |
|
30152
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
1472 visibility. MOUSE_FACE_P non-zero means compare the mouse_face_p |
|
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
1473 flags of A and B, too. */ |
| 25012 | 1474 |
| 1475 static INLINE int | |
|
30152
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
1476 row_equal_p (w, a, b, mouse_face_p) |
| 25012 | 1477 struct window *w; |
| 1478 struct glyph_row *a, *b; | |
|
30152
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
1479 int mouse_face_p; |
| 25012 | 1480 { |
| 1481 if (a == b) | |
| 1482 return 1; | |
| 1483 else if (a->hash != b->hash) | |
| 1484 return 0; | |
| 1485 else | |
| 1486 { | |
| 1487 struct glyph *a_glyph, *b_glyph, *a_end; | |
| 1488 int area; | |
| 1489 | |
|
30152
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
1490 if (mouse_face_p && a->mouse_face_p != b->mouse_face_p) |
|
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
1491 return 0; |
|
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
1492 |
| 25012 | 1493 /* Compare glyphs. */ |
| 1494 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area < LAST_AREA; ++area) | |
| 1495 { | |
| 1496 if (a->used[area] != b->used[area]) | |
| 1497 return 0; | |
| 1498 | |
| 1499 a_glyph = a->glyphs[area]; | |
| 1500 a_end = a_glyph + a->used[area]; | |
| 1501 b_glyph = b->glyphs[area]; | |
| 1502 | |
| 1503 while (a_glyph < a_end | |
| 1504 && GLYPH_EQUAL_P (a_glyph, b_glyph)) | |
| 1505 ++a_glyph, ++b_glyph; | |
| 1506 | |
| 1507 if (a_glyph != a_end) | |
| 1508 return 0; | |
| 1509 } | |
| 1510 | |
| 1511 if (a->truncated_on_left_p != b->truncated_on_left_p | |
| 1512 || a->fill_line_p != b->fill_line_p | |
| 1513 || a->truncated_on_right_p != b->truncated_on_right_p | |
| 1514 || a->overlay_arrow_p != b->overlay_arrow_p | |
| 1515 || a->continued_p != b->continued_p | |
| 1516 || a->indicate_empty_line_p != b->indicate_empty_line_p | |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
1517 || a->overlapped_p != b->overlapped_p |
| 25012 | 1518 || (MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (a) |
| 1519 != MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (b)) | |
| 1520 /* Different partially visible characters on left margin. */ | |
| 1521 || a->x != b->x | |
| 1522 /* Different height. */ | |
| 1523 || a->ascent != b->ascent | |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
1524 || a->phys_ascent != b->phys_ascent |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
1525 || a->phys_height != b->phys_height |
| 25012 | 1526 || a->visible_height != b->visible_height) |
| 1527 return 0; | |
| 1528 } | |
| 1529 | |
| 1530 return 1; | |
| 1531 } | |
| 1532 | |
| 1533 | |
| 314 | 1534 |
| 25012 | 1535 /*********************************************************************** |
| 1536 Glyph Pool | |
| 1537 | |
| 1538 See dispextern.h for an overall explanation of glyph pools. | |
| 1539 ***********************************************************************/ | |
| 1540 | |
| 1541 /* Allocate a glyph_pool structure. The structure returned is | |
| 1542 initialized with zeros. The global variable glyph_pool_count is | |
| 1543 incremented for each pool allocated. */ | |
| 1544 | |
| 1545 static struct glyph_pool * | |
| 1546 new_glyph_pool () | |
| 1547 { | |
| 1548 struct glyph_pool *result; | |
| 1549 | |
| 1550 /* Allocate a new glyph_pool and clear it. */ | |
| 1551 result = (struct glyph_pool *) xmalloc (sizeof *result); | |
| 1552 bzero (result, sizeof *result); | |
| 1553 | |
| 1554 /* For memory leak and double deletion checking. */ | |
| 1555 ++glyph_pool_count; | |
| 1556 | |
| 1557 return result; | |
| 1558 } | |
| 1559 | |
| 1560 | |
| 1561 /* Free a glyph_pool structure POOL. The function may be called with | |
| 1562 a null POOL pointer. The global variable glyph_pool_count is | |
| 1563 decremented with every pool structure freed. If this count gets | |
| 1564 negative, more structures were freed than allocated, i.e. one | |
| 1565 structure must have been freed more than once or a bogus pointer | |
| 1566 was passed to free_glyph_pool. */ | |
| 1567 | |
| 1568 static void | |
| 1569 free_glyph_pool (pool) | |
| 1570 struct glyph_pool *pool; | |
| 1571 { | |
| 1572 if (pool) | |
| 1573 { | |
|
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
1574 /* More freed than allocated? */ |
| 25012 | 1575 --glyph_pool_count; |
| 1576 xassert (glyph_pool_count >= 0); | |
| 1577 | |
| 1578 xfree (pool->glyphs); | |
| 1579 xfree (pool); | |
| 1580 } | |
| 1581 } | |
| 1582 | |
| 1583 | |
| 1584 /* Enlarge a glyph pool POOL. MATRIX_DIM gives the number of rows and | |
| 1585 columns we need. This function never shrinks a pool. The only | |
| 1586 case in which this would make sense, would be when a frame's size | |
| 1587 is changed from a large value to a smaller one. But, if someone | |
| 1588 does it once, we can expect that he will do it again. | |
| 1589 | |
| 1590 Value is non-zero if the pool changed in a way which makes | |
| 1591 re-adjusting window glyph matrices necessary. */ | |
| 1592 | |
| 1593 static int | |
| 1594 realloc_glyph_pool (pool, matrix_dim) | |
| 1595 struct glyph_pool *pool; | |
| 1596 struct dim matrix_dim; | |
| 1597 { | |
| 1598 int needed; | |
| 1599 int changed_p; | |
| 1600 | |
| 1601 changed_p = (pool->glyphs == 0 | |
| 1602 || matrix_dim.height != pool->nrows | |
| 1603 || matrix_dim.width != pool->ncolumns); | |
| 1604 | |
| 1605 /* Enlarge the glyph pool. */ | |
| 1606 needed = matrix_dim.width * matrix_dim.height; | |
| 1607 if (needed > pool->nglyphs) | |
| 1608 { | |
| 1609 int size = needed * sizeof (struct glyph); | |
| 1610 | |
| 1611 if (pool->glyphs) | |
| 1612 pool->glyphs = (struct glyph *) xrealloc (pool->glyphs, size); | |
| 1613 else | |
| 1614 { | |
| 1615 pool->glyphs = (struct glyph *) xmalloc (size); | |
| 1616 bzero (pool->glyphs, size); | |
| 1617 } | |
| 1618 | |
| 1619 pool->nglyphs = needed; | |
| 1620 } | |
| 1621 | |
|
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
1622 /* Remember the number of rows and columns because (a) we use them |
| 25012 | 1623 to do sanity checks, and (b) the number of columns determines |
| 1624 where rows in the frame matrix start---this must be available to | |
| 1625 determine pointers to rows of window sub-matrices. */ | |
| 1626 pool->nrows = matrix_dim.height; | |
| 1627 pool->ncolumns = matrix_dim.width; | |
| 1628 | |
| 1629 return changed_p; | |
| 1630 } | |
| 1631 | |
| 1632 | |
| 1633 | |
| 1634 /*********************************************************************** | |
| 1635 Debug Code | |
| 1636 ***********************************************************************/ | |
| 1637 | |
| 1638 #if GLYPH_DEBUG | |
| 1639 | |
|
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1640 |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1641 /* Flush standard output. This is sometimes useful to call from |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1642 the debugger. */ |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1643 |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1644 void |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1645 flush_stdout () |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1646 { |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1647 fflush (stdout); |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1648 } |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1649 |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1650 |
| 25012 | 1651 /* Check that no glyph pointers have been lost in MATRIX. If a |
| 1652 pointer has been lost, e.g. by using a structure assignment between | |
| 1653 rows, at least one pointer must occur more than once in the rows of | |
| 1654 MATRIX. */ | |
| 1655 | |
| 1656 void | |
| 1657 check_matrix_pointer_lossage (matrix) | |
| 1658 struct glyph_matrix *matrix; | |
| 1659 { | |
| 1660 int i, j; | |
| 1661 | |
| 1662 for (i = 0; i < matrix->nrows; ++i) | |
| 1663 for (j = 0; j < matrix->nrows; ++j) | |
| 1664 xassert (i == j | |
| 1665 || (matrix->rows[i].glyphs[TEXT_AREA] | |
| 1666 != matrix->rows[j].glyphs[TEXT_AREA])); | |
| 1667 } | |
| 1668 | |
| 1669 | |
| 1670 /* Get a pointer to glyph row ROW in MATRIX, with bounds checks. */ | |
| 1671 | |
| 1672 struct glyph_row * | |
| 1673 matrix_row (matrix, row) | |
| 1674 struct glyph_matrix *matrix; | |
| 1675 int row; | |
| 1676 { | |
| 1677 xassert (matrix && matrix->rows); | |
| 1678 xassert (row >= 0 && row < matrix->nrows); | |
| 1679 | |
| 1680 /* That's really too slow for normal testing because this function | |
| 1681 is called almost everywhere. Although---it's still astonishingly | |
| 1682 fast, so it is valuable to have for debugging purposes. */ | |
| 314 | 1683 #if 0 |
| 25012 | 1684 check_matrix_pointer_lossage (matrix); |
| 1685 #endif | |
| 1686 | |
| 1687 return matrix->rows + row; | |
| 1688 } | |
| 1689 | |
| 1690 | |
| 1691 #if 0 /* This function makes invalid assumptions when text is | |
| 1692 partially invisible. But it might come handy for debugging | |
| 1693 nevertheless. */ | |
| 1694 | |
| 1695 /* Check invariants that must hold for an up to date current matrix of | |
| 1696 window W. */ | |
| 1697 | |
| 1698 static void | |
| 1699 check_matrix_invariants (w) | |
| 314 | 1700 struct window *w; |
| 1701 { | |
| 25012 | 1702 struct glyph_matrix *matrix = w->current_matrix; |
| 1703 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w); | |
| 1704 struct glyph_row *row = matrix->rows; | |
| 1705 struct glyph_row *last_text_row = NULL; | |
| 1706 struct buffer *saved = current_buffer; | |
| 1707 struct buffer *buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer); | |
| 1708 int c; | |
| 1709 | |
| 1710 /* This can sometimes happen for a fresh window. */ | |
| 1711 if (matrix->nrows < 2) | |
| 1712 return; | |
| 1713 | |
| 1714 set_buffer_temp (buffer); | |
| 1715 | |
| 1716 /* Note: last row is always reserved for the mode line. */ | |
| 1717 while (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row) | |
| 1718 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < yb) | |
| 1719 { | |
| 1720 struct glyph_row *next = row + 1; | |
| 1721 | |
| 1722 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)) | |
| 1723 last_text_row = row; | |
| 1724 | |
| 1725 /* Check that character and byte positions are in sync. */ | |
| 1726 xassert (MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row) | |
| 1727 == CHAR_TO_BYTE (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row))); | |
| 1728 | |
| 1729 /* CHAR_TO_BYTE aborts when invoked for a position > Z. We can | |
| 1730 have such a position temporarily in case of a minibuffer | |
| 1731 displaying something like `[Sole completion]' at its end. */ | |
| 1732 if (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) < BUF_ZV (current_buffer)) | |
| 1733 xassert (MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) | |
| 1734 == CHAR_TO_BYTE (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))); | |
| 1735 | |
| 1736 /* Check that end position of `row' is equal to start position | |
| 1737 of next row. */ | |
| 1738 if (next->enabled_p && MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (next)) | |
| 1739 { | |
| 1740 xassert (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) | |
| 1741 == MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (next)); | |
| 1742 xassert (MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) | |
| 1743 == MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (next)); | |
| 1744 } | |
| 1745 row = next; | |
| 1746 } | |
| 1747 | |
| 1748 xassert (w->current_matrix->nrows == w->desired_matrix->nrows); | |
| 1749 xassert (w->desired_matrix->rows != NULL); | |
| 1750 set_buffer_temp (saved); | |
| 1751 } | |
| 1752 | |
| 1753 #endif /* 0 */ | |
| 1754 | |
| 1755 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */ | |
| 1756 | |
| 1757 | |
| 1758 | |
| 1759 /********************************************************************** | |
| 1760 Allocating/ Adjusting Glyph Matrices | |
| 1761 **********************************************************************/ | |
| 1762 | |
| 1763 /* Allocate glyph matrices over a window tree for a frame-based | |
| 1764 redisplay | |
| 1765 | |
| 1766 X and Y are column/row within the frame glyph matrix where | |
| 1767 sub-matrices for the window tree rooted at WINDOW must be | |
| 1768 allocated. CH_DIM contains the dimensions of the smallest | |
| 1769 character that could be used during display. DIM_ONLY_P non-zero | |
| 1770 means that the caller of this function is only interested in the | |
| 1771 result matrix dimension, and matrix adjustments should not be | |
| 1772 performed. | |
| 1773 | |
| 1774 The function returns the total width/height of the sub-matrices of | |
| 1775 the window tree. If called on a frame root window, the computation | |
| 1776 will take the mini-buffer window into account. | |
| 1777 | |
| 1778 *WINDOW_CHANGE_FLAGS is set to a bit mask with bits | |
| 1779 | |
| 1780 NEW_LEAF_MATRIX set if any window in the tree did not have a | |
| 1781 glyph matrices yet, and | |
| 1782 | |
| 1783 CHANGED_LEAF_MATRIX set if the dimension or location of a matrix of | |
| 1784 any window in the tree will be changed or have been changed (see | |
|
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
1785 DIM_ONLY_P) |
| 25012 | 1786 |
| 1787 *WINDOW_CHANGE_FLAGS must be initialized by the caller of this | |
| 1788 function. | |
| 1789 | |
| 1790 Windows are arranged into chains of windows on the same level | |
| 1791 through the next fields of window structures. Such a level can be | |
| 1792 either a sequence of horizontally adjacent windows from left to | |
| 1793 right, or a sequence of vertically adjacent windows from top to | |
| 1794 bottom. Each window in a horizontal sequence can be either a leaf | |
| 1795 window or a vertical sequence; a window in a vertical sequence can | |
| 1796 be either a leaf or a horizontal sequence. All windows in a | |
| 1797 horizontal sequence have the same height, and all windows in a | |
| 1798 vertical sequence have the same width. | |
| 1799 | |
| 1800 This function uses, for historical reasons, a more general | |
| 1801 algorithm to determine glyph matrix dimensions that would be | |
| 1802 necessary. | |
| 1803 | |
| 1804 The matrix height of a horizontal sequence is determined by the | |
| 1805 maximum height of any matrix in the sequence. The matrix width of | |
| 1806 a horizontal sequence is computed by adding up matrix widths of | |
| 1807 windows in the sequence. | |
| 1808 | |
| 1809 |<------- result width ------->| | |
| 1810 +---------+----------+---------+ --- | |
| 1811 | | | | | | |
| 1812 | | | | | |
| 1813 +---------+ | | result height | |
| 1814 | +---------+ | |
| 1815 | | | | |
| 1816 +----------+ --- | |
| 1817 | |
| 1818 The matrix width of a vertical sequence is the maximum matrix width | |
| 1819 of any window in the sequence. Its height is computed by adding up | |
| 1820 matrix heights of windows in the sequence. | |
| 1821 | |
| 1822 |<---- result width -->| | |
| 1823 +---------+ --- | |
| 1824 | | | | |
| 1825 | | | | |
| 1826 +---------+--+ | | |
| 1827 | | | | |
| 1828 | | result height | |
| 1829 | | | |
| 1830 +------------+---------+ | | |
| 1831 | | | | |
| 1832 | | | | |
| 1833 +------------+---------+ --- */ | |
| 1834 | |
| 1835 /* Bit indicating that a new matrix will be allocated or has been | |
| 1836 allocated. */ | |
| 1837 | |
| 1838 #define NEW_LEAF_MATRIX (1 << 0) | |
| 1839 | |
| 1840 /* Bit indicating that a matrix will or has changed its location or | |
| 1841 size. */ | |
| 1842 | |
| 1843 #define CHANGED_LEAF_MATRIX (1 << 1) | |
| 1844 | |
| 1845 static struct dim | |
|
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1846 allocate_matrices_for_frame_redisplay (window, x, y, dim_only_p, |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1847 window_change_flags) |
| 25012 | 1848 Lisp_Object window; |
| 1849 int x, y; | |
| 1850 int dim_only_p; | |
| 1851 int *window_change_flags; | |
| 1852 { | |
| 1853 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (window))); | |
| 1854 int x0 = x, y0 = y; | |
| 1855 int wmax = 0, hmax = 0; | |
| 1856 struct dim total; | |
| 1857 struct dim dim; | |
| 1858 struct window *w; | |
| 1859 int in_horz_combination_p; | |
| 1860 | |
| 1861 /* What combination is WINDOW part of? Compute this once since the | |
| 1862 result is the same for all windows in the `next' chain. The | |
| 1863 special case of a root window (parent equal to nil) is treated | |
| 1864 like a vertical combination because a root window's `next' | |
| 1865 points to the mini-buffer window, if any, which is arranged | |
| 1866 vertically below other windows. */ | |
| 1867 in_horz_combination_p | |
| 1868 = (!NILP (XWINDOW (window)->parent) | |
| 1869 && !NILP (XWINDOW (XWINDOW (window)->parent)->hchild)); | |
| 1870 | |
| 1871 /* For WINDOW and all windows on the same level. */ | |
| 1872 do | |
| 1873 { | |
| 1874 w = XWINDOW (window); | |
| 1875 | |
| 1876 /* Get the dimension of the window sub-matrix for W, depending | |
|
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
1877 on whether this is a combination or a leaf window. */ |
| 25012 | 1878 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) |
|
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1879 dim = allocate_matrices_for_frame_redisplay (w->hchild, x, y, |
| 25012 | 1880 dim_only_p, |
| 1881 window_change_flags); | |
| 1882 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) | |
|
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1883 dim = allocate_matrices_for_frame_redisplay (w->vchild, x, y, |
| 25012 | 1884 dim_only_p, |
| 1885 window_change_flags); | |
| 1886 else | |
| 1887 { | |
| 1888 /* If not already done, allocate sub-matrix structures. */ | |
| 1889 if (w->desired_matrix == NULL) | |
| 1890 { | |
| 1891 w->desired_matrix = new_glyph_matrix (f->desired_pool); | |
| 1892 w->current_matrix = new_glyph_matrix (f->current_pool); | |
| 1893 *window_change_flags |= NEW_LEAF_MATRIX; | |
| 1894 } | |
| 1895 | |
| 1896 /* Width and height MUST be chosen so that there are no | |
| 1897 holes in the frame matrix. */ | |
|
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1898 dim.width = required_matrix_width (w); |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1899 dim.height = required_matrix_height (w); |
| 25012 | 1900 |
| 1901 /* Will matrix be re-allocated? */ | |
| 1902 if (x != w->desired_matrix->matrix_x | |
| 1903 || y != w->desired_matrix->matrix_y | |
| 1904 || dim.width != w->desired_matrix->matrix_w | |
| 1905 || dim.height != w->desired_matrix->matrix_h | |
| 1906 || (margin_glyphs_to_reserve (w, dim.width, | |
| 1907 w->right_margin_width) | |
| 1908 != w->desired_matrix->left_margin_glyphs) | |
| 1909 || (margin_glyphs_to_reserve (w, dim.width, | |
| 1910 w->left_margin_width) | |
| 1911 != w->desired_matrix->right_margin_glyphs)) | |
| 1912 *window_change_flags |= CHANGED_LEAF_MATRIX; | |
| 1913 | |
| 1914 /* Actually change matrices, if allowed. Do not consider | |
| 1915 CHANGED_LEAF_MATRIX computed above here because the pool | |
| 1916 may have been changed which we don't now here. We trust | |
| 1917 that we only will be called with DIM_ONLY_P != 0 when | |
| 1918 necessary. */ | |
| 1919 if (!dim_only_p) | |
| 1920 { | |
| 1921 adjust_glyph_matrix (w, w->desired_matrix, x, y, dim); | |
| 1922 adjust_glyph_matrix (w, w->current_matrix, x, y, dim); | |
| 1923 } | |
| 1924 } | |
| 1925 | |
| 1926 /* If we are part of a horizontal combination, advance x for | |
| 1927 windows to the right of W; otherwise advance y for windows | |
| 1928 below W. */ | |
| 1929 if (in_horz_combination_p) | |
| 1930 x += dim.width; | |
| 1931 else | |
| 1932 y += dim.height; | |
| 1933 | |
| 1934 /* Remember maximum glyph matrix dimensions. */ | |
| 1935 wmax = max (wmax, dim.width); | |
| 1936 hmax = max (hmax, dim.height); | |
| 1937 | |
| 1938 /* Next window on same level. */ | |
| 1939 window = w->next; | |
| 1940 } | |
| 1941 while (!NILP (window)); | |
| 1942 | |
| 1943 /* Set `total' to the total glyph matrix dimension of this window | |
| 1944 level. In a vertical combination, the width is the width of the | |
| 1945 widest window; the height is the y we finally reached, corrected | |
| 1946 by the y we started with. In a horizontal combination, the total | |
| 1947 height is the height of the tallest window, and the width is the | |
| 1948 x we finally reached, corrected by the x we started with. */ | |
| 1949 if (in_horz_combination_p) | |
| 1950 { | |
| 1951 total.width = x - x0; | |
| 1952 total.height = hmax; | |
| 1953 } | |
| 1954 else | |
| 1955 { | |
| 1956 total.width = wmax; | |
| 1957 total.height = y - y0; | |
| 1958 } | |
| 1959 | |
| 1960 return total; | |
| 1961 } | |
| 1962 | |
| 1963 | |
|
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1964 /* Return the required height of glyph matrices for window W. */ |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1965 |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1966 int |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1967 required_matrix_height (w) |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1968 struct window *w; |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1969 { |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1970 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1971 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame); |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1972 |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1973 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)) |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1974 { |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1975 int ch_height = FRAME_SMALLEST_FONT_HEIGHT (f); |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1976 int window_pixel_height = window_box_height (w) + abs (w->vscroll); |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1977 return (((window_pixel_height + ch_height - 1) |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1978 / ch_height) |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1979 /* One partially visible line at the top and |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1980 bottom of the window. */ |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1981 + 2 |
|
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
1982 /* 2 for header and mode line. */ |
|
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1983 + 2); |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1984 } |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1985 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */ |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1986 |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1987 return XINT (w->height); |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1988 } |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1989 |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1990 |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1991 /* Return the required width of glyph matrices for window W. */ |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1992 |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1993 int |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1994 required_matrix_width (w) |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1995 struct window *w; |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1996 { |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1997 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1998 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame); |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1999 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)) |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2000 { |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2001 int ch_width = FRAME_SMALLEST_CHAR_WIDTH (f); |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2002 int window_pixel_width = XFLOATINT (w->width) * CANON_X_UNIT (f); |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2003 |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2004 /* Compute number of glyphs needed in a glyph row. */ |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2005 return (((window_pixel_width + ch_width - 1) |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2006 / ch_width) |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2007 /* 2 partially visible columns in the text area. */ |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2008 + 2 |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2009 /* One partially visible column at the right |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2010 edge of each marginal area. */ |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2011 + 1 + 1); |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2012 } |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2013 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */ |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2014 |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2015 return XINT (w->width); |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2016 } |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2017 |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2018 |
| 25012 | 2019 /* Allocate window matrices for window-based redisplay. W is the |
| 2020 window whose matrices must be allocated/reallocated. CH_DIM is the | |
| 2021 size of the smallest character that could potentially be used on W. */ | |
| 2022 | |
| 2023 static void | |
|
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2024 allocate_matrices_for_window_redisplay (w) |
| 25012 | 2025 struct window *w; |
| 2026 { | |
| 2027 while (w) | |
| 314 | 2028 { |
| 25012 | 2029 if (!NILP (w->vchild)) |
|
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2030 allocate_matrices_for_window_redisplay (XWINDOW (w->vchild)); |
| 25012 | 2031 else if (!NILP (w->hchild)) |
|
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2032 allocate_matrices_for_window_redisplay (XWINDOW (w->hchild)); |
| 25012 | 2033 else |
| 314 | 2034 { |
| 25012 | 2035 /* W is a leaf window. */ |
| 2036 struct dim dim; | |
| 2037 | |
| 2038 /* If matrices are not yet allocated, allocate them now. */ | |
| 2039 if (w->desired_matrix == NULL) | |
| 314 | 2040 { |
| 25012 | 2041 w->desired_matrix = new_glyph_matrix (NULL); |
| 2042 w->current_matrix = new_glyph_matrix (NULL); | |
| 314 | 2043 } |
| 25012 | 2044 |
|
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2045 dim.width = required_matrix_width (w); |
|
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2046 dim.height = required_matrix_height (w); |
| 25012 | 2047 adjust_glyph_matrix (w, w->desired_matrix, 0, 0, dim); |
| 2048 adjust_glyph_matrix (w, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, dim); | |
| 2049 } | |
| 2050 | |
| 2051 w = NILP (w->next) ? NULL : XWINDOW (w->next); | |
| 2052 } | |
| 2053 } | |
| 2054 | |
| 2055 | |
| 2056 /* Re-allocate/ re-compute glyph matrices on frame F. If F is null, | |
| 2057 do it for all frames; otherwise do it just for the given frame. | |
| 2058 This function must be called when a new frame is created, its size | |
| 2059 changes, or its window configuration changes. */ | |
| 2060 | |
| 2061 void | |
| 2062 adjust_glyphs (f) | |
| 2063 struct frame *f; | |
| 2064 { | |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
2065 /* Block input so that expose events and other events that access |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
2066 glyph matrices are not processed while we are changing them. */ |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
2067 BLOCK_INPUT; |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
2068 |
| 25012 | 2069 if (f) |
| 2070 adjust_frame_glyphs (f); | |
| 2071 else | |
| 2072 { | |
| 2073 Lisp_Object tail, lisp_frame; | |
| 2074 | |
| 2075 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, lisp_frame) | |
| 2076 adjust_frame_glyphs (XFRAME (lisp_frame)); | |
| 2077 } | |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
2078 |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
2079 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
| 25012 | 2080 } |
| 2081 | |
| 2082 | |
| 2083 /* Adjust frame glyphs when Emacs is initialized. | |
| 2084 | |
| 2085 To be called from init_display. | |
| 2086 | |
| 2087 We need a glyph matrix because redraw will happen soon. | |
| 2088 Unfortunately, window sizes on selected_frame are not yet set to | |
| 2089 meaningful values. I believe we can assume that there are only two | |
| 2090 windows on the frame---the mini-buffer and the root window. Frame | |
| 2091 height and width seem to be correct so far. So, set the sizes of | |
| 2092 windows to estimated values. */ | |
| 2093 | |
| 2094 static void | |
| 2095 adjust_frame_glyphs_initially () | |
| 2096 { | |
|
25666
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
2097 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME (); |
|
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
2098 struct window *root = XWINDOW (sf->root_window); |
| 25012 | 2099 struct window *mini = XWINDOW (root->next); |
|
25666
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
2100 int frame_height = FRAME_HEIGHT (sf); |
|
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
2101 int frame_width = FRAME_WIDTH (sf); |
|
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
2102 int top_margin = FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (sf); |
| 25012 | 2103 |
| 2104 /* Do it for the root window. */ | |
| 2105 XSETFASTINT (root->top, top_margin); | |
| 2106 XSETFASTINT (root->width, frame_width); | |
|
25666
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
2107 set_window_height (sf->root_window, frame_height - 1 - top_margin, 0); |
| 25012 | 2108 |
| 2109 /* Do it for the mini-buffer window. */ | |
| 2110 XSETFASTINT (mini->top, frame_height - 1); | |
| 2111 XSETFASTINT (mini->width, frame_width); | |
| 2112 set_window_height (root->next, 1, 0); | |
| 2113 | |
|
25666
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
2114 adjust_frame_glyphs (sf); |
| 25012 | 2115 glyphs_initialized_initially_p = 1; |
| 2116 } | |
| 2117 | |
| 2118 | |
| 2119 /* Allocate/reallocate glyph matrices of a single frame F. */ | |
| 2120 | |
| 2121 static void | |
| 2122 adjust_frame_glyphs (f) | |
| 2123 struct frame *f; | |
| 2124 { | |
| 2125 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)) | |
| 2126 adjust_frame_glyphs_for_window_redisplay (f); | |
| 2127 else | |
| 2128 adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay (f); | |
| 2129 | |
| 2130 /* Don't forget the message buffer and the buffer for | |
| 2131 decode_mode_spec. */ | |
| 2132 adjust_frame_message_buffer (f); | |
| 2133 adjust_decode_mode_spec_buffer (f); | |
| 2134 | |
| 2135 f->glyphs_initialized_p = 1; | |
| 2136 } | |
| 2137 | |
| 2138 | |
|
34736
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2139 /* In the window tree with root W, build current matrices of leaf |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2140 windows from the frame's current matrix. */ |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2141 |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2142 static void |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2143 fake_current_matrices (window) |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2144 Lisp_Object window; |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2145 { |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2146 struct window *w; |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2147 |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2148 for (; !NILP (window); window = w->next) |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2149 { |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2150 w = XWINDOW (window); |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2151 |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2152 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2153 fake_current_matrices (w->hchild); |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2154 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2155 fake_current_matrices (w->vchild); |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2156 else |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2157 { |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2158 int i; |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2159 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame); |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2160 struct glyph_matrix *m = w->current_matrix; |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2161 struct glyph_matrix *fm = f->current_matrix; |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2162 |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2163 xassert (m->matrix_h == XFASTINT (w->height)); |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2164 xassert (m->matrix_w == XFASTINT (w->width)); |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2165 |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2166 for (i = 0; i < m->matrix_h; ++i) |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2167 { |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2168 struct glyph_row *r = m->rows + i; |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2169 struct glyph_row *fr = fm->rows + i + XFASTINT (w->top); |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2170 |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2171 xassert (r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] >= fr->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2172 && r->glyphs[LAST_AREA] <= fr->glyphs[LAST_AREA]); |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2173 |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2174 r->enabled_p = fr->enabled_p; |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2175 if (r->enabled_p) |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2176 { |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2177 r->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] = m->left_margin_glyphs; |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2178 r->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] = m->right_margin_glyphs; |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2179 r->used[TEXT_AREA] = (m->matrix_w |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2180 - r->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2181 - r->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA]); |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2182 r->mode_line_p = 0; |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2183 } |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2184 } |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2185 } |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2186 } |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2187 } |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2188 |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2189 |
|
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2190 /* Save away the contents of frame F's current frame matrix. Value is |
|
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
2191 a glyph matrix holding the contents of F's current frame matrix. */ |
|
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2192 |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2193 static struct glyph_matrix * |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2194 save_current_matrix (f) |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2195 struct frame *f; |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2196 { |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2197 int i; |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2198 struct glyph_matrix *saved; |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2199 |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2200 saved = (struct glyph_matrix *) xmalloc (sizeof *saved); |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2201 bzero (saved, sizeof *saved); |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2202 saved->nrows = f->current_matrix->nrows; |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2203 saved->rows = (struct glyph_row *) xmalloc (saved->nrows |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2204 * sizeof *saved->rows); |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2205 bzero (saved->rows, saved->nrows * sizeof *saved->rows); |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2206 |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2207 for (i = 0; i < saved->nrows; ++i) |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2208 { |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2209 struct glyph_row *from = f->current_matrix->rows + i; |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2210 struct glyph_row *to = saved->rows + i; |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2211 size_t nbytes = from->used[TEXT_AREA] * sizeof (struct glyph); |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2212 to->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] = (struct glyph *) xmalloc (nbytes); |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2213 bcopy (from->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], to->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], nbytes); |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2214 to->used[TEXT_AREA] = from->used[TEXT_AREA]; |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2215 } |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2216 |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2217 return saved; |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2218 } |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2219 |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2220 |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2221 /* Restore the contents of frame F's current frame matrix from SAVED, |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2222 and free memory associated with SAVED. */ |
|
34849
eac70be4cb58
(save_frame_matrix, restore_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34788
diff
changeset
|
2223 |
|
eac70be4cb58
(save_frame_matrix, restore_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34788
diff
changeset
|
2224 static void |
|
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2225 restore_current_matrix (f, saved) |
|
34849
eac70be4cb58
(save_frame_matrix, restore_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34788
diff
changeset
|
2226 struct frame *f; |
|
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2227 struct glyph_matrix *saved; |
|
34736
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2228 { |
|
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2229 int i; |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2230 |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2231 for (i = 0; i < saved->nrows; ++i) |
|
34788
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2232 { |
|
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2233 struct glyph_row *from = saved->rows + i; |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2234 struct glyph_row *to = f->current_matrix->rows + i; |
|
34788
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2235 size_t nbytes = from->used[TEXT_AREA] * sizeof (struct glyph); |
|
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2236 bcopy (from->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], to->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], nbytes); |
|
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2237 to->used[TEXT_AREA] = from->used[TEXT_AREA]; |
|
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2238 xfree (from->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]); |
|
34788
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2239 } |
|
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2240 |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2241 xfree (saved->rows); |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2242 xfree (saved); |
|
34736
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2243 } |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2244 |
|
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2245 |
|
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2246 |
| 25012 | 2247 /* Allocate/reallocate glyph matrices of a single frame F for |
| 2248 frame-based redisplay. */ | |
| 2249 | |
| 2250 static void | |
| 2251 adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay (f) | |
| 2252 struct frame *f; | |
| 2253 { | |
| 2254 struct dim ch_dim; | |
| 2255 struct dim matrix_dim; | |
| 2256 int pool_changed_p; | |
| 2257 int window_change_flags; | |
| 2258 int top_window_y; | |
| 2259 | |
| 2260 if (!FRAME_LIVE_P (f)) | |
| 2261 return; | |
| 2262 | |
| 2263 /* Determine the smallest character in any font for F. On | |
| 2264 console windows, all characters have dimension (1, 1). */ | |
| 2265 ch_dim.width = ch_dim.height = 1; | |
| 2266 | |
| 2267 top_window_y = FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f); | |
| 2268 | |
| 2269 /* Allocate glyph pool structures if not already done. */ | |
| 2270 if (f->desired_pool == NULL) | |
| 2271 { | |
| 2272 f->desired_pool = new_glyph_pool (); | |
| 2273 f->current_pool = new_glyph_pool (); | |
| 2274 } | |
| 2275 | |
| 2276 /* Allocate frames matrix structures if needed. */ | |
| 2277 if (f->desired_matrix == NULL) | |
| 2278 { | |
| 2279 f->desired_matrix = new_glyph_matrix (f->desired_pool); | |
| 2280 f->current_matrix = new_glyph_matrix (f->current_pool); | |
| 2281 } | |
|
34736
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2282 |
| 25012 | 2283 /* Compute window glyph matrices. (This takes the mini-buffer |
| 2284 window into account). The result is the size of the frame glyph | |
| 2285 matrix needed. The variable window_change_flags is set to a bit | |
| 2286 mask indicating whether new matrices will be allocated or | |
| 2287 existing matrices change their size or location within the frame | |
| 2288 matrix. */ | |
| 2289 window_change_flags = 0; | |
| 2290 matrix_dim | |
| 2291 = allocate_matrices_for_frame_redisplay (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f), | |
| 2292 0, top_window_y, | |
|
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2293 1, |
| 25012 | 2294 &window_change_flags); |
| 2295 | |
| 2296 /* Add in menu bar lines, if any. */ | |
| 2297 matrix_dim.height += top_window_y; | |
| 2298 | |
| 2299 /* Enlarge pools as necessary. */ | |
| 2300 pool_changed_p = realloc_glyph_pool (f->desired_pool, matrix_dim); | |
| 2301 realloc_glyph_pool (f->current_pool, matrix_dim); | |
| 2302 | |
| 2303 /* Set up glyph pointers within window matrices. Do this only if | |
| 2304 absolutely necessary since it requires a frame redraw. */ | |
| 2305 if (pool_changed_p || window_change_flags) | |
| 2306 { | |
| 2307 /* Do it for window matrices. */ | |
| 2308 allocate_matrices_for_frame_redisplay (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f), | |
|
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2309 0, top_window_y, 0, |
| 25012 | 2310 &window_change_flags); |
| 2311 | |
| 2312 /* Size of frame matrices must equal size of frame. Note | |
| 2313 that we are called for X frames with window widths NOT equal | |
| 2314 to the frame width (from CHANGE_FRAME_SIZE_1). */ | |
| 2315 xassert (matrix_dim.width == FRAME_WIDTH (f) | |
| 2316 && matrix_dim.height == FRAME_HEIGHT (f)); | |
| 2317 | |
|
34788
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2318 /* Pointers to glyph memory in glyph rows are exchanged during |
|
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2319 the update phase of redisplay, which means in general that a |
|
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2320 frame's current matrix consists of pointers into both the |
|
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2321 desired and current glyph pool of the frame. Adjusting a |
|
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2322 matrix sets the frame matrix up so that pointers are all into |
|
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2323 the same pool. If we want to preserve glyph contents of the |
|
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2324 current matrix over a call to adjust_glyph_matrix, we must |
|
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2325 make a copy of the current glyphs, and restore the current |
|
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2326 matrix' contents from that copy. */ |
|
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2327 if (display_completed |
|
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2328 && !FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f) |
|
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2329 && matrix_dim.width == f->current_matrix->matrix_w |
|
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2330 && matrix_dim.height == f->current_matrix->matrix_h) |
|
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2331 { |
|
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2332 struct glyph_matrix *copy = save_current_matrix (f); |
|
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2333 adjust_glyph_matrix (NULL, f->desired_matrix, 0, 0, matrix_dim); |
|
34788
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2334 adjust_glyph_matrix (NULL, f->current_matrix, 0, 0, matrix_dim); |
|
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2335 restore_current_matrix (f, copy); |
|
34788
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2336 fake_current_matrices (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)); |
|
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2337 } |
|
34736
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2338 else |
|
34788
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2339 { |
|
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2340 adjust_glyph_matrix (NULL, f->desired_matrix, 0, 0, matrix_dim); |
|
34788
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2341 adjust_glyph_matrix (NULL, f->current_matrix, 0, 0, matrix_dim); |
|
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2342 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f); |
|
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2343 } |
| 25012 | 2344 } |
| 2345 } | |
| 2346 | |
| 2347 | |
| 2348 /* Allocate/reallocate glyph matrices of a single frame F for | |
| 2349 window-based redisplay. */ | |
| 2350 | |
| 2351 static void | |
| 2352 adjust_frame_glyphs_for_window_redisplay (f) | |
| 2353 struct frame *f; | |
| 2354 { | |
| 2355 struct dim ch_dim; | |
| 2356 struct window *w; | |
| 2357 | |
| 2358 xassert (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) && FRAME_LIVE_P (f)); | |
| 2359 | |
| 2360 /* Get minimum sizes. */ | |
| 2361 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM | |
| 2362 ch_dim.width = FRAME_SMALLEST_CHAR_WIDTH (f); | |
| 2363 ch_dim.height = FRAME_SMALLEST_FONT_HEIGHT (f); | |
| 2364 #else | |
| 2365 ch_dim.width = ch_dim.height = 1; | |
| 2366 #endif | |
| 2367 | |
| 2368 /* Allocate/reallocate window matrices. */ | |
|
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2369 allocate_matrices_for_window_redisplay (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f))); |
| 25012 | 2370 |
| 2371 /* Allocate/ reallocate matrices of the dummy window used to display | |
| 2372 the menu bar under X when no X toolkit support is available. */ | |
| 2373 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT | |
| 2374 { | |
| 2375 /* Allocate a dummy window if not already done. */ | |
| 2376 if (NILP (f->menu_bar_window)) | |
| 2377 { | |
| 2378 f->menu_bar_window = make_window (); | |
| 2379 w = XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window); | |
| 2380 XSETFRAME (w->frame, f); | |
| 2381 w->pseudo_window_p = 1; | |
| 2382 } | |
| 2383 else | |
| 2384 w = XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window); | |
| 2385 | |
| 2386 /* Set window dimensions to frame dimensions and allocate or | |
| 2387 adjust glyph matrices of W. */ | |
| 2388 XSETFASTINT (w->top, 0); | |
| 2389 XSETFASTINT (w->left, 0); | |
| 2390 XSETFASTINT (w->height, FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f)); | |
| 2391 XSETFASTINT (w->width, FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (f)); | |
|
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2392 allocate_matrices_for_window_redisplay (w); |
| 25012 | 2393 } |
| 2394 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */ | |
| 2395 | |
|
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2396 /* Allocate/ reallocate matrices of the tool bar window. If we |
|
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2397 don't have a tool bar window yet, make one. */ |
|
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2398 if (NILP (f->tool_bar_window)) |
| 25012 | 2399 { |
|
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2400 f->tool_bar_window = make_window (); |
|
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2401 w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window); |
| 25012 | 2402 XSETFRAME (w->frame, f); |
| 2403 w->pseudo_window_p = 1; | |
| 2404 } | |
| 2405 else | |
|
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2406 w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window); |
| 25012 | 2407 |
| 2408 XSETFASTINT (w->top, FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f)); | |
| 2409 XSETFASTINT (w->left, 0); | |
|
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2410 XSETFASTINT (w->height, FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f)); |
| 25012 | 2411 XSETFASTINT (w->width, FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (f)); |
|
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2412 allocate_matrices_for_window_redisplay (w); |
| 25012 | 2413 } |
| 2414 | |
| 2415 | |
| 2416 /* Adjust/ allocate message buffer of frame F. | |
| 2417 | |
| 2418 Note that the message buffer is never freed. Since I could not | |
| 2419 find a free in 19.34, I assume that freeing it would be | |
| 2420 problematic in some way and don't do it either. | |
| 2421 | |
| 2422 (Implementation note: It should be checked if we can free it | |
| 2423 eventually without causing trouble). */ | |
| 2424 | |
| 2425 static void | |
| 2426 adjust_frame_message_buffer (f) | |
| 2427 struct frame *f; | |
| 2428 { | |
| 2429 int size = FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE (f) + 1; | |
| 2430 | |
| 2431 if (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f)) | |
| 2432 { | |
| 2433 char *buffer = FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f); | |
| 2434 char *new_buffer = (char *) xrealloc (buffer, size); | |
| 2435 FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f) = new_buffer; | |
| 2436 } | |
| 2437 else | |
| 2438 FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f) = (char *) xmalloc (size); | |
| 2439 } | |
| 2440 | |
| 2441 | |
| 2442 /* Re-allocate buffer for decode_mode_spec on frame F. */ | |
| 2443 | |
| 2444 static void | |
| 2445 adjust_decode_mode_spec_buffer (f) | |
| 2446 struct frame *f; | |
| 2447 { | |
| 2448 f->decode_mode_spec_buffer | |
| 2449 = (char *) xrealloc (f->decode_mode_spec_buffer, | |
| 2450 FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE (f) + 1); | |
| 2451 } | |
| 2452 | |
| 2453 | |
| 2454 | |
| 2455 /********************************************************************** | |
| 2456 Freeing Glyph Matrices | |
| 2457 **********************************************************************/ | |
| 2458 | |
| 2459 /* Free glyph memory for a frame F. F may be null. This function can | |
| 2460 be called for the same frame more than once. The root window of | |
| 2461 F may be nil when this function is called. This is the case when | |
| 2462 the function is called when F is destroyed. */ | |
| 2463 | |
| 2464 void | |
| 2465 free_glyphs (f) | |
| 2466 struct frame *f; | |
| 2467 { | |
| 2468 if (f && f->glyphs_initialized_p) | |
| 2469 { | |
|
27968
7634011b93f3
(free_glyphs): Block input while freeing matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27855
diff
changeset
|
2470 /* Block interrupt input so that we don't get surprised by an X |
|
7634011b93f3
(free_glyphs): Block input while freeing matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27855
diff
changeset
|
2471 event while we're in an inconsistent state. */ |
|
7634011b93f3
(free_glyphs): Block input while freeing matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27855
diff
changeset
|
2472 BLOCK_INPUT; |
| 25012 | 2473 f->glyphs_initialized_p = 0; |
| 2474 | |
| 2475 /* Release window sub-matrices. */ | |
| 2476 if (!NILP (f->root_window)) | |
| 2477 free_window_matrices (XWINDOW (f->root_window)); | |
| 2478 | |
| 2479 /* Free the dummy window for menu bars without X toolkit and its | |
| 2480 glyph matrices. */ | |
| 2481 if (!NILP (f->menu_bar_window)) | |
| 2482 { | |
| 2483 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window); | |
| 2484 free_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix); | |
| 2485 free_glyph_matrix (w->current_matrix); | |
| 2486 w->desired_matrix = w->current_matrix = NULL; | |
| 2487 f->menu_bar_window = Qnil; | |
| 2488 } | |
| 2489 | |
|
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2490 /* Free the tool bar window and its glyph matrices. */ |
|
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2491 if (!NILP (f->tool_bar_window)) |
| 25012 | 2492 { |
|
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2493 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window); |
| 25012 | 2494 free_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix); |
| 2495 free_glyph_matrix (w->current_matrix); | |
| 2496 w->desired_matrix = w->current_matrix = NULL; | |
|
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2497 f->tool_bar_window = Qnil; |
| 25012 | 2498 } |
| 2499 | |
| 2500 /* Release frame glyph matrices. Reset fields to zero in | |
| 2501 case we are called a second time. */ | |
| 2502 if (f->desired_matrix) | |
| 2503 { | |
| 2504 free_glyph_matrix (f->desired_matrix); | |
| 2505 free_glyph_matrix (f->current_matrix); | |
| 2506 f->desired_matrix = f->current_matrix = NULL; | |
| 2507 } | |
| 2508 | |
| 2509 /* Release glyph pools. */ | |
| 2510 if (f->desired_pool) | |
| 2511 { | |
| 2512 free_glyph_pool (f->desired_pool); | |
| 2513 free_glyph_pool (f->current_pool); | |
| 2514 f->desired_pool = f->current_pool = NULL; | |
| 314 | 2515 } |
|
27968
7634011b93f3
(free_glyphs): Block input while freeing matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27855
diff
changeset
|
2516 |
|
7634011b93f3
(free_glyphs): Block input while freeing matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27855
diff
changeset
|
2517 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
| 314 | 2518 } |
| 2519 } | |
| 2520 | |
| 25012 | 2521 |
| 2522 /* Free glyph sub-matrices in the window tree rooted at W. This | |
| 2523 function may be called with a null pointer, and it may be called on | |
| 2524 the same tree more than once. */ | |
| 2525 | |
| 2526 void | |
| 2527 free_window_matrices (w) | |
| 2528 struct window *w; | |
| 2529 { | |
| 2530 while (w) | |
| 2531 { | |
| 2532 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) | |
| 2533 free_window_matrices (XWINDOW (w->hchild)); | |
| 2534 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) | |
| 2535 free_window_matrices (XWINDOW (w->vchild)); | |
| 2536 else | |
| 2537 { | |
| 2538 /* This is a leaf window. Free its memory and reset fields | |
| 2539 to zero in case this function is called a second time for | |
| 2540 W. */ | |
| 2541 free_glyph_matrix (w->current_matrix); | |
| 2542 free_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix); | |
| 2543 w->current_matrix = w->desired_matrix = NULL; | |
| 2544 } | |
| 2545 | |
| 2546 /* Next window on same level. */ | |
| 2547 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); | |
| 2548 } | |
| 2549 } | |
| 2550 | |
| 2551 | |
| 2552 /* Check glyph memory leaks. This function is called from | |
| 2553 shut_down_emacs. Note that frames are not destroyed when Emacs | |
| 2554 exits. We therefore free all glyph memory for all active frames | |
| 2555 explicitly and check that nothing is left allocated. */ | |
|
6620
990d7d5095dc
(adjust_window_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6617
diff
changeset
|
2556 |
|
990d7d5095dc
(adjust_window_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6617
diff
changeset
|
2557 void |
| 25012 | 2558 check_glyph_memory () |
|
6620
990d7d5095dc
(adjust_window_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6617
diff
changeset
|
2559 { |
| 25012 | 2560 Lisp_Object tail, frame; |
| 2561 | |
| 2562 /* Free glyph memory for all frames. */ | |
| 2563 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame) | |
| 2564 free_glyphs (XFRAME (frame)); | |
| 2565 | |
| 2566 /* Check that nothing is left allocated. */ | |
| 2567 if (glyph_matrix_count) | |
| 2568 abort (); | |
| 2569 if (glyph_pool_count) | |
| 2570 abort (); | |
| 2571 } | |
| 2572 | |
| 2573 | |
| 2574 | |
| 2575 /********************************************************************** | |
| 2576 Building a Frame Matrix | |
| 2577 **********************************************************************/ | |
| 2578 | |
| 2579 /* Most of the redisplay code works on glyph matrices attached to | |
| 2580 windows. This is a good solution most of the time, but it is not | |
| 2581 suitable for terminal code. Terminal output functions cannot rely | |
| 2582 on being able to set an arbitrary terminal window. Instead they | |
| 2583 must be provided with a view of the whole frame, i.e. the whole | |
| 2584 screen. We build such a view by constructing a frame matrix from | |
| 2585 window matrices in this section. | |
| 2586 | |
| 2587 Windows that must be updated have their must_be_update_p flag set. | |
| 2588 For all such windows, their desired matrix is made part of the | |
| 2589 desired frame matrix. For other windows, their current matrix is | |
| 2590 made part of the desired frame matrix. | |
| 2591 | |
| 2592 +-----------------+----------------+ | |
| 2593 | desired | desired | | |
| 2594 | | | | |
| 2595 +-----------------+----------------+ | |
| 2596 | current | | |
| 2597 | | | |
| 2598 +----------------------------------+ | |
| 2599 | |
| 2600 Desired window matrices can be made part of the frame matrix in a | |
| 2601 cheap way: We exploit the fact that the desired frame matrix and | |
| 2602 desired window matrices share their glyph memory. This is not | |
| 2603 possible for current window matrices. Their glyphs are copied to | |
| 2604 the desired frame matrix. The latter is equivalent to | |
| 2605 preserve_other_columns in the old redisplay. | |
| 2606 | |
| 2607 Used glyphs counters for frame matrix rows are the result of adding | |
| 2608 up glyph lengths of the window matrices. A line in the frame | |
| 2609 matrix is enabled, if a corresponding line in a window matrix is | |
| 2610 enabled. | |
| 2611 | |
| 2612 After building the desired frame matrix, it will be passed to | |
| 2613 terminal code, which will manipulate both the desired and current | |
| 2614 frame matrix. Changes applied to the frame's current matrix have | |
| 2615 to be visible in current window matrices afterwards, of course. | |
| 2616 | |
| 2617 This problem is solved like this: | |
| 2618 | |
| 2619 1. Window and frame matrices share glyphs. Window matrices are | |
| 2620 constructed in a way that their glyph contents ARE the glyph | |
| 2621 contents needed in a frame matrix. Thus, any modification of | |
| 2622 glyphs done in terminal code will be reflected in window matrices | |
| 2623 automatically. | |
| 2624 | |
| 2625 2. Exchanges of rows in a frame matrix done by terminal code are | |
| 2626 intercepted by hook functions so that corresponding row operations | |
| 2627 on window matrices can be performed. This is necessary because we | |
| 2628 use pointers to glyphs in glyph row structures. To satisfy the | |
| 2629 assumption of point 1 above that glyphs are updated implicitly in | |
| 2630 window matrices when they are manipulated via the frame matrix, | |
| 2631 window and frame matrix must of course agree where to find the | |
| 2632 glyphs for their rows. Possible manipulations that must be | |
| 2633 mirrored are assignments of rows of the desired frame matrix to the | |
| 2634 current frame matrix and scrolling the current frame matrix. */ | |
| 2635 | |
| 2636 /* Build frame F's desired matrix from window matrices. Only windows | |
| 2637 which have the flag must_be_updated_p set have to be updated. Menu | |
| 2638 bar lines of a frame are not covered by window matrices, so make | |
| 2639 sure not to touch them in this function. */ | |
| 2640 | |
| 2641 static void | |
| 2642 build_frame_matrix (f) | |
| 2643 struct frame *f; | |
| 2644 { | |
|
6620
990d7d5095dc
(adjust_window_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6617
diff
changeset
|
2645 int i; |
|
990d7d5095dc
(adjust_window_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6617
diff
changeset
|
2646 |
| 25012 | 2647 /* F must have a frame matrix when this function is called. */ |
| 2648 xassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)); | |
| 2649 | |
| 2650 /* Clear all rows in the frame matrix covered by window matrices. | |
| 2651 Menu bar lines are not covered by windows. */ | |
| 2652 for (i = FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f); i < f->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i) | |
| 2653 clear_glyph_row (MATRIX_ROW (f->desired_matrix, i)); | |
| 2654 | |
| 2655 /* Build the matrix by walking the window tree. */ | |
| 2656 build_frame_matrix_from_window_tree (f->desired_matrix, | |
| 2657 XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f))); | |
| 2658 } | |
| 2659 | |
| 2660 | |
| 2661 /* Walk a window tree, building a frame matrix MATRIX from window | |
| 2662 matrices. W is the root of a window tree. */ | |
| 2663 | |
| 2664 static void | |
| 2665 build_frame_matrix_from_window_tree (matrix, w) | |
| 2666 struct glyph_matrix *matrix; | |
| 2667 struct window *w; | |
| 2668 { | |
| 2669 while (w) | |
|
6620
990d7d5095dc
(adjust_window_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6617
diff
changeset
|
2670 { |
| 25012 | 2671 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) |
| 2672 build_frame_matrix_from_window_tree (matrix, XWINDOW (w->hchild)); | |
| 2673 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) | |
| 2674 build_frame_matrix_from_window_tree (matrix, XWINDOW (w->vchild)); | |
| 2675 else | |
| 2676 build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window (matrix, w); | |
| 2677 | |
| 2678 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); | |
|
6620
990d7d5095dc
(adjust_window_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6617
diff
changeset
|
2679 } |
|
990d7d5095dc
(adjust_window_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6617
diff
changeset
|
2680 } |
|
6642
2fda5dd17356
(verify_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6627
diff
changeset
|
2681 |
| 25012 | 2682 |
| 2683 /* Add a window's matrix to a frame matrix. FRAME_MATRIX is the | |
| 2684 desired frame matrix built. W is a leaf window whose desired or | |
| 2685 current matrix is to be added to FRAME_MATRIX. W's flag | |
| 2686 must_be_updated_p determines which matrix it contributes to | |
| 2687 FRAME_MATRIX. If must_be_updated_p is non-zero, W's desired matrix | |
| 2688 is added to FRAME_MATRIX, otherwise W's current matrix is added. | |
| 2689 Adding a desired matrix means setting up used counters and such in | |
| 2690 frame rows, while adding a current window matrix to FRAME_MATRIX | |
| 2691 means copying glyphs. The latter case corresponds to | |
| 2692 preserve_other_columns in the old redisplay. */ | |
| 2693 | |
| 2694 static void | |
| 2695 build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window (frame_matrix, w) | |
| 2696 struct glyph_matrix *frame_matrix; | |
|
6642
2fda5dd17356
(verify_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6627
diff
changeset
|
2697 struct window *w; |
|
2fda5dd17356
(verify_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6627
diff
changeset
|
2698 { |
| 25012 | 2699 struct glyph_matrix *window_matrix; |
| 2700 int window_y, frame_y; | |
| 2701 /* If non-zero, a glyph to insert at the right border of W. */ | |
| 2702 GLYPH right_border_glyph = 0; | |
| 2703 | |
| 2704 /* Set window_matrix to the matrix we have to add to FRAME_MATRIX. */ | |
| 2705 if (w->must_be_updated_p) | |
| 2706 { | |
| 2707 window_matrix = w->desired_matrix; | |
| 2708 | |
| 2709 /* Decide whether we want to add a vertical border glyph. */ | |
| 2710 if (!WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)) | |
| 2711 { | |
| 2712 struct Lisp_Char_Table *dp = window_display_table (w); | |
| 2713 right_border_glyph = (dp && INTEGERP (DISP_BORDER_GLYPH (dp)) | |
| 2714 ? XINT (DISP_BORDER_GLYPH (dp)) | |
| 2715 : '|'); | |
| 2716 } | |
| 2717 } | |
| 2718 else | |
| 2719 window_matrix = w->current_matrix; | |
| 2720 | |
| 2721 /* For all rows in the window matrix and corresponding rows in the | |
| 2722 frame matrix. */ | |
| 2723 window_y = 0; | |
| 2724 frame_y = window_matrix->matrix_y; | |
| 2725 while (window_y < window_matrix->nrows) | |
|
6642
2fda5dd17356
(verify_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6627
diff
changeset
|
2726 { |
| 25012 | 2727 struct glyph_row *frame_row = frame_matrix->rows + frame_y; |
| 2728 struct glyph_row *window_row = window_matrix->rows + window_y; | |
|
31271
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2729 int current_row_p = window_matrix == w->current_matrix; |
| 25012 | 2730 |
| 2731 /* Fill up the frame row with spaces up to the left margin of the | |
| 2732 window row. */ | |
| 2733 fill_up_frame_row_with_spaces (frame_row, window_matrix->matrix_x); | |
| 2734 | |
| 2735 /* Fill up areas in the window matrix row with spaces. */ | |
| 2736 fill_up_glyph_row_with_spaces (window_row); | |
|
31271
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2737 |
|
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2738 /* If only part of W's desired matrix has been built, and |
|
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2739 window_row wasn't displayed, use the corresponding current |
|
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2740 row instead. */ |
|
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2741 if (window_matrix == w->desired_matrix |
|
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2742 && !window_row->enabled_p) |
|
6682
16ab14205588
(verify_charstarts): Handle truncation of lines.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6648
diff
changeset
|
2743 { |
|
31271
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2744 window_row = w->current_matrix->rows + window_y; |
|
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2745 current_row_p = 1; |
|
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2746 } |
|
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2747 |
|
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2748 if (current_row_p) |
|
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2749 { |
|
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2750 /* Copy window row to frame row. */ |
| 25012 | 2751 bcopy (window_row->glyphs[0], |
| 2752 frame_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + window_matrix->matrix_x, | |
| 2753 window_matrix->matrix_w * sizeof (struct glyph)); | |
| 2754 } | |
| 2755 else | |
| 2756 { | |
|
31271
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2757 xassert (window_row->enabled_p); |
|
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2758 |
|
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2759 /* Only when a desired row has been displayed, we want |
|
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2760 the corresponding frame row to be updated. */ |
|
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2761 frame_row->enabled_p = 1; |
|
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2762 |
| 25012 | 2763 /* Maybe insert a vertical border between horizontally adjacent |
| 2764 windows. */ | |
| 2765 if (right_border_glyph) | |
| 2766 { | |
| 2767 struct glyph *border = window_row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] - 1; | |
| 2768 SET_CHAR_GLYPH_FROM_GLYPH (*border, right_border_glyph); | |
| 2769 } | |
| 2770 | |
|
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2771 /* Window row window_y must be a slice of frame row |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2772 frame_y. */ |
| 25012 | 2773 xassert (glyph_row_slice_p (window_row, frame_row)); |
|
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2774 |
| 25012 | 2775 /* If rows are in sync, we don't have to copy glyphs because |
| 2776 frame and window share glyphs. */ | |
|
25241
35674d7c4136
(mirror_make_current): If desired row isn't enabled,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25190
diff
changeset
|
2777 |
|
35674d7c4136
(mirror_make_current): If desired row isn't enabled,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25190
diff
changeset
|
2778 #if GLYPH_DEBUG |
|
35674d7c4136
(mirror_make_current): If desired row isn't enabled,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25190
diff
changeset
|
2779 strcpy (w->current_matrix->method, w->desired_matrix->method); |
|
34866
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
2780 add_window_display_history (w, w->current_matrix->method, 0); |
|
25241
35674d7c4136
(mirror_make_current): If desired row isn't enabled,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25190
diff
changeset
|
2781 #endif |
| 25012 | 2782 } |
| 2783 | |
| 2784 /* Set number of used glyphs in the frame matrix. Since we fill | |
| 2785 up with spaces, and visit leaf windows from left to right it | |
| 2786 can be done simply. */ | |
| 2787 frame_row->used[TEXT_AREA] | |
| 2788 = window_matrix->matrix_x + window_matrix->matrix_w; | |
| 2789 | |
| 2790 /* Next row. */ | |
| 2791 ++window_y; | |
| 2792 ++frame_y; | |
| 2793 } | |
| 2794 } | |
| 2795 | |
| 2796 | |
| 2797 /* Add spaces to a glyph row ROW in a window matrix. | |
| 2798 | |
| 2799 Each row has the form: | |
| 2800 | |
| 2801 +---------+-----------------------------+------------+ | |
| 2802 | left | text | right | | |
| 2803 +---------+-----------------------------+------------+ | |
| 2804 | |
| 2805 Left and right marginal areas are optional. This function adds | |
| 2806 spaces to areas so that there are no empty holes between areas. | |
| 2807 In other words: If the right area is not empty, the text area | |
| 2808 is filled up with spaces up to the right area. If the text area | |
| 2809 is not empty, the left area is filled up. | |
| 2810 | |
| 2811 To be called for frame-based redisplay, only. */ | |
| 2812 | |
| 2813 static void | |
| 2814 fill_up_glyph_row_with_spaces (row) | |
| 2815 struct glyph_row *row; | |
| 2816 { | |
| 2817 fill_up_glyph_row_area_with_spaces (row, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA); | |
| 2818 fill_up_glyph_row_area_with_spaces (row, TEXT_AREA); | |
| 2819 fill_up_glyph_row_area_with_spaces (row, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA); | |
| 2820 } | |
| 2821 | |
| 2822 | |
| 2823 /* Fill area AREA of glyph row ROW with spaces. To be called for | |
| 2824 frame-based redisplay only. */ | |
| 2825 | |
| 2826 static void | |
| 2827 fill_up_glyph_row_area_with_spaces (row, area) | |
| 2828 struct glyph_row *row; | |
| 2829 int area; | |
| 2830 { | |
| 2831 if (row->glyphs[area] < row->glyphs[area + 1]) | |
| 2832 { | |
| 2833 struct glyph *end = row->glyphs[area + 1]; | |
| 2834 struct glyph *text = row->glyphs[area] + row->used[area]; | |
| 2835 | |
| 2836 while (text < end) | |
| 2837 *text++ = space_glyph; | |
| 2838 row->used[area] = text - row->glyphs[area]; | |
| 2839 } | |
| 2840 } | |
| 2841 | |
| 2842 | |
| 2843 /* Add spaces to the end of ROW in a frame matrix until index UPTO is | |
| 2844 reached. In frame matrices only one area, TEXT_AREA, is used. */ | |
| 2845 | |
| 2846 static void | |
| 2847 fill_up_frame_row_with_spaces (row, upto) | |
| 2848 struct glyph_row *row; | |
| 2849 int upto; | |
| 2850 { | |
| 2851 int i = row->used[TEXT_AREA]; | |
| 2852 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; | |
| 2853 | |
| 2854 while (i < upto) | |
| 2855 glyph[i++] = space_glyph; | |
| 2856 | |
| 2857 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = i; | |
| 2858 } | |
| 2859 | |
| 2860 | |
| 2861 | |
| 2862 /********************************************************************** | |
| 2863 Mirroring operations on frame matrices in window matrices | |
| 2864 **********************************************************************/ | |
| 2865 | |
| 2866 /* Set frame being updated via frame-based redisplay to F. This | |
| 2867 function must be called before updates to make explicit that we are | |
| 2868 working on frame matrices or not. */ | |
| 2869 | |
| 2870 static INLINE void | |
| 2871 set_frame_matrix_frame (f) | |
| 2872 struct frame *f; | |
| 2873 { | |
| 2874 frame_matrix_frame = f; | |
| 2875 } | |
| 2876 | |
| 2877 | |
| 2878 /* Make sure glyph row ROW in CURRENT_MATRIX is up to date. | |
| 2879 DESIRED_MATRIX is the desired matrix corresponding to | |
| 2880 CURRENT_MATRIX. The update is done by exchanging glyph pointers | |
| 2881 between rows in CURRENT_MATRIX and DESIRED_MATRIX. If | |
| 2882 frame_matrix_frame is non-null, this indicates that the exchange is | |
| 2883 done in frame matrices, and that we have to perform analogous | |
| 2884 operations in window matrices of frame_matrix_frame. */ | |
| 2885 | |
| 2886 static INLINE void | |
| 2887 make_current (desired_matrix, current_matrix, row) | |
| 2888 struct glyph_matrix *desired_matrix, *current_matrix; | |
| 2889 int row; | |
| 2890 { | |
| 2891 struct glyph_row *current_row = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, row); | |
| 2892 struct glyph_row *desired_row = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, row); | |
|
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
2893 int mouse_face_p = current_row->mouse_face_p; |
| 25012 | 2894 |
| 2895 /* Do current_row = desired_row. This exchanges glyph pointers | |
| 2896 between both rows, and does a structure assignment otherwise. */ | |
| 2897 assign_row (current_row, desired_row); | |
| 2898 | |
| 2899 /* Enable current_row to mark it as valid. */ | |
| 2900 current_row->enabled_p = 1; | |
|
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
2901 current_row->mouse_face_p = mouse_face_p; |
| 25012 | 2902 |
| 2903 /* If we are called on frame matrices, perform analogous operations | |
| 2904 for window matrices. */ | |
| 2905 if (frame_matrix_frame) | |
| 2906 mirror_make_current (XWINDOW (frame_matrix_frame->root_window), row); | |
| 2907 } | |
| 2908 | |
| 2909 | |
| 2910 /* W is the root of a window tree. FRAME_ROW is the index of a row in | |
| 2911 W's frame which has been made current (by swapping pointers between | |
| 2912 current and desired matrix). Perform analogous operations in the | |
| 2913 matrices of leaf windows in the window tree rooted at W. */ | |
| 2914 | |
| 2915 static void | |
| 2916 mirror_make_current (w, frame_row) | |
| 2917 struct window *w; | |
| 2918 int frame_row; | |
| 2919 { | |
| 2920 while (w) | |
| 2921 { | |
| 2922 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) | |
| 2923 mirror_make_current (XWINDOW (w->hchild), frame_row); | |
| 2924 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) | |
| 2925 mirror_make_current (XWINDOW (w->vchild), frame_row); | |
| 2926 else | |
| 2927 { | |
| 2928 /* Row relative to window W. Don't use FRAME_TO_WINDOW_VPOS | |
| 2929 here because the checks performed in debug mode there | |
| 2930 will not allow the conversion. */ | |
| 2931 int row = frame_row - w->desired_matrix->matrix_y; | |
| 2932 | |
| 2933 /* If FRAME_ROW is within W, assign the desired row to the | |
| 2934 current row (exchanging glyph pointers). */ | |
| 2935 if (row >= 0 && row < w->desired_matrix->matrix_h) | |
|
6682
16ab14205588
(verify_charstarts): Handle truncation of lines.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6648
diff
changeset
|
2936 { |
| 25012 | 2937 struct glyph_row *current_row |
| 2938 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, row); | |
| 2939 struct glyph_row *desired_row | |
| 2940 = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, row); | |
|
25241
35674d7c4136
(mirror_make_current): If desired row isn't enabled,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25190
diff
changeset
|
2941 |
|
35674d7c4136
(mirror_make_current): If desired row isn't enabled,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25190
diff
changeset
|
2942 if (desired_row->enabled_p) |
|
35674d7c4136
(mirror_make_current): If desired row isn't enabled,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25190
diff
changeset
|
2943 assign_row (current_row, desired_row); |
|
35674d7c4136
(mirror_make_current): If desired row isn't enabled,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25190
diff
changeset
|
2944 else |
|
35674d7c4136
(mirror_make_current): If desired row isn't enabled,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25190
diff
changeset
|
2945 swap_glyph_pointers (desired_row, current_row); |
| 25012 | 2946 current_row->enabled_p = 1; |
|
6682
16ab14205588
(verify_charstarts): Handle truncation of lines.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6648
diff
changeset
|
2947 } |
|
16ab14205588
(verify_charstarts): Handle truncation of lines.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6648
diff
changeset
|
2948 } |
| 25012 | 2949 |
| 2950 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); | |
|
6642
2fda5dd17356
(verify_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6627
diff
changeset
|
2951 } |
|
2fda5dd17356
(verify_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6627
diff
changeset
|
2952 } |
| 25012 | 2953 |
| 2954 | |
| 2955 /* Perform row dance after scrolling. We are working on the range of | |
| 2956 lines UNCHANGED_AT_TOP + 1 to UNCHANGED_AT_TOP + NLINES (not | |
| 2957 including) in MATRIX. COPY_FROM is a vector containing, for each | |
| 2958 row I in the range 0 <= I < NLINES, the index of the original line | |
| 2959 to move to I. This index is relative to the row range, i.e. 0 <= | |
| 2960 index < NLINES. RETAINED_P is a vector containing zero for each | |
| 2961 row 0 <= I < NLINES which is empty. | |
| 2962 | |
| 2963 This function is called from do_scrolling and do_direct_scrolling. */ | |
| 2964 | |
| 2965 void | |
| 2966 mirrored_line_dance (matrix, unchanged_at_top, nlines, copy_from, | |
| 2967 retained_p) | |
| 2968 struct glyph_matrix *matrix; | |
| 2969 int unchanged_at_top, nlines; | |
| 2970 int *copy_from; | |
| 2971 char *retained_p; | |
| 2972 { | |
| 2973 /* A copy of original rows. */ | |
| 2974 struct glyph_row *old_rows; | |
| 2975 | |
| 2976 /* Rows to assign to. */ | |
| 2977 struct glyph_row *new_rows = MATRIX_ROW (matrix, unchanged_at_top); | |
| 2978 | |
| 2979 int i; | |
| 2980 | |
| 2981 /* Make a copy of the original rows. */ | |
| 2982 old_rows = (struct glyph_row *) alloca (nlines * sizeof *old_rows); | |
| 2983 bcopy (new_rows, old_rows, nlines * sizeof *old_rows); | |
| 2984 | |
| 2985 /* Assign new rows, maybe clear lines. */ | |
| 2986 for (i = 0; i < nlines; ++i) | |
| 2987 { | |
| 2988 int enabled_before_p = new_rows[i].enabled_p; | |
| 2989 | |
| 2990 xassert (i + unchanged_at_top < matrix->nrows); | |
| 2991 xassert (unchanged_at_top + copy_from[i] < matrix->nrows); | |
| 2992 new_rows[i] = old_rows[copy_from[i]]; | |
| 2993 new_rows[i].enabled_p = enabled_before_p; | |
| 2994 | |
| 2995 /* RETAINED_P is zero for empty lines. */ | |
| 2996 if (!retained_p[copy_from[i]]) | |
| 2997 new_rows[i].enabled_p = 0; | |
| 2998 } | |
| 2999 | |
|
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
3000 /* Do the same for window matrices, if MATRIX is a frame matrix. */ |
| 25012 | 3001 if (frame_matrix_frame) |
| 3002 mirror_line_dance (XWINDOW (frame_matrix_frame->root_window), | |
| 3003 unchanged_at_top, nlines, copy_from, retained_p); | |
| 3004 } | |
| 3005 | |
| 3006 | |
|
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3007 /* Synchronize glyph pointers in the current matrix of window W with |
|
40214
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
3008 the current frame matrix. */ |
|
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3009 |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3010 static void |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3011 sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows (w) |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3012 struct window *w; |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3013 { |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3014 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame); |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3015 struct glyph_row *window_row, *window_row_end, *frame_row; |
|
40271
ae4848857075
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Remove unused variable `area'.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
40214
diff
changeset
|
3016 int left, right, x, width; |
|
40214
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
3017 |
|
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
3018 /* Preconditions: W must be a leaf window on a tty frame. */ |
|
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3019 xassert (NILP (w->hchild) && NILP (w->vchild)); |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3020 xassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)); |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3021 |
|
40214
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
3022 left = margin_glyphs_to_reserve (w, 1, w->left_margin_width); |
|
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
3023 right = margin_glyphs_to_reserve (w, 1, w->right_margin_width); |
|
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
3024 x = w->current_matrix->matrix_x; |
|
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
3025 width = w->current_matrix->matrix_w; |
|
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
3026 |
|
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3027 window_row = w->current_matrix->rows; |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3028 window_row_end = window_row + w->current_matrix->nrows; |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3029 frame_row = f->current_matrix->rows + XFASTINT (w->top); |
|
40214
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
3030 |
|
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
3031 for (; window_row < window_row_end; ++window_row, ++frame_row) |
|
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3032 { |
|
40214
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
3033 window_row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] |
|
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
3034 = frame_row->glyphs[0] + x; |
|
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
3035 window_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] |
|
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
3036 = window_row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] + left; |
|
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
3037 window_row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] |
|
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
3038 = window_row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] + width; |
|
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
3039 window_row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] |
|
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
3040 = window_row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] - right; |
|
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3041 } |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3042 } |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3043 |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3044 |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3045 /* Return the window in the window tree rooted in W containing frame |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3046 row ROW. Value is null if none is found. */ |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3047 |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3048 struct window * |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3049 frame_row_to_window (w, row) |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3050 struct window *w; |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3051 int row; |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3052 { |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3053 struct window *found = NULL; |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3054 |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3055 while (w && !found) |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3056 { |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3057 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3058 found = frame_row_to_window (XWINDOW (w->hchild), row); |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3059 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3060 found = frame_row_to_window (XWINDOW (w->vchild), row); |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3061 else if (row >= XFASTINT (w->top) |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3062 && row < XFASTINT (w->top) + XFASTINT (w->height)) |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3063 found = w; |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3064 |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3065 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3066 } |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3067 |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3068 return found; |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3069 } |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3070 |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3071 |
| 25012 | 3072 /* Perform a line dance in the window tree rooted at W, after |
| 3073 scrolling a frame matrix in mirrored_line_dance. | |
| 3074 | |
| 3075 We are working on the range of lines UNCHANGED_AT_TOP + 1 to | |
| 3076 UNCHANGED_AT_TOP + NLINES (not including) in W's frame matrix. | |
| 3077 COPY_FROM is a vector containing, for each row I in the range 0 <= | |
| 3078 I < NLINES, the index of the original line to move to I. This | |
| 3079 index is relative to the row range, i.e. 0 <= index < NLINES. | |
| 3080 RETAINED_P is a vector containing zero for each row 0 <= I < NLINES | |
| 3081 which is empty. */ | |
| 3082 | |
| 3083 static void | |
| 3084 mirror_line_dance (w, unchanged_at_top, nlines, copy_from, retained_p) | |
| 3085 struct window *w; | |
| 3086 int unchanged_at_top, nlines; | |
| 3087 int *copy_from; | |
| 3088 char *retained_p; | |
| 3089 { | |
| 3090 while (w) | |
| 3091 { | |
| 3092 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) | |
| 3093 mirror_line_dance (XWINDOW (w->hchild), unchanged_at_top, | |
| 3094 nlines, copy_from, retained_p); | |
| 3095 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) | |
| 3096 mirror_line_dance (XWINDOW (w->vchild), unchanged_at_top, | |
| 3097 nlines, copy_from, retained_p); | |
| 3098 else | |
| 3099 { | |
| 3100 /* W is a leaf window, and we are working on its current | |
| 3101 matrix m. */ | |
| 3102 struct glyph_matrix *m = w->current_matrix; | |
|
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3103 int i, sync_p = 0; |
| 25012 | 3104 struct glyph_row *old_rows; |
| 3105 | |
| 3106 /* Make a copy of the original rows of matrix m. */ | |
| 3107 old_rows = (struct glyph_row *) alloca (m->nrows * sizeof *old_rows); | |
| 3108 bcopy (m->rows, old_rows, m->nrows * sizeof *old_rows); | |
| 3109 | |
| 3110 for (i = 0; i < nlines; ++i) | |
| 3111 { | |
| 3112 /* Frame relative line assigned to. */ | |
| 3113 int frame_to = i + unchanged_at_top; | |
| 3114 | |
| 3115 /* Frame relative line assigned. */ | |
| 3116 int frame_from = copy_from[i] + unchanged_at_top; | |
| 3117 | |
| 3118 /* Window relative line assigned to. */ | |
| 3119 int window_to = frame_to - m->matrix_y; | |
| 3120 | |
| 3121 /* Window relative line assigned. */ | |
| 3122 int window_from = frame_from - m->matrix_y; | |
| 3123 | |
| 3124 /* Is assigned line inside window? */ | |
| 3125 int from_inside_window_p | |
| 3126 = window_from >= 0 && window_from < m->matrix_h; | |
| 3127 | |
|
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3128 /* Is assigned to line inside window? */ |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3129 int to_inside_window_p |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3130 = window_to >= 0 && window_to < m->matrix_h; |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3131 |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3132 if (from_inside_window_p && to_inside_window_p) |
| 25012 | 3133 { |
| 3134 /* Enabled setting before assignment. */ | |
| 3135 int enabled_before_p; | |
| 3136 | |
| 3137 /* Do the assignment. The enabled_p flag is saved | |
| 3138 over the assignment because the old redisplay did | |
| 3139 that. */ | |
| 3140 enabled_before_p = m->rows[window_to].enabled_p; | |
| 3141 m->rows[window_to] = old_rows[window_from]; | |
| 3142 m->rows[window_to].enabled_p = enabled_before_p; | |
| 3143 | |
| 3144 /* If frame line is empty, window line is empty, too. */ | |
| 3145 if (!retained_p[copy_from[i]]) | |
| 3146 m->rows[window_to].enabled_p = 0; | |
| 3147 } | |
|
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3148 else if (to_inside_window_p) |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3149 { |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3150 /* A copy between windows. This is an infrequent |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3151 case not worth optimizing. */ |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3152 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame); |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3153 struct window *root = XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)); |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3154 struct window *w2; |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3155 struct glyph_matrix *m2; |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3156 int m2_from; |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3157 |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3158 w2 = frame_row_to_window (root, frame_to); |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3159 m2 = w2->current_matrix; |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3160 m2_from = frame_from - m2->matrix_y; |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3161 copy_row_except_pointers (m->rows + window_to, |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3162 m2->rows + m2_from); |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3163 |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3164 /* If frame line is empty, window line is empty, too. */ |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3165 if (!retained_p[copy_from[i]]) |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3166 m->rows[window_to].enabled_p = 0; |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3167 sync_p = 1; |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3168 } |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3169 else if (from_inside_window_p) |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3170 sync_p = 1; |
| 25012 | 3171 } |
|
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3172 |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3173 /* If there was a copy between windows, make sure glyph |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3174 pointers are in sync with the frame matrix. */ |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3175 if (sync_p) |
|
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3176 sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows (w); |
| 25012 | 3177 |
| 3178 /* Check that no pointers are lost. */ | |
| 3179 CHECK_MATRIX (m); | |
| 3180 } | |
| 3181 | |
| 3182 /* Next window on same level. */ | |
| 3183 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); | |
| 3184 } | |
| 3185 } | |
| 3186 | |
| 3187 | |
| 3188 #if GLYPH_DEBUG | |
| 3189 | |
| 3190 /* Check that window and frame matrices agree about their | |
| 3191 understanding where glyphs of the rows are to find. For each | |
| 3192 window in the window tree rooted at W, check that rows in the | |
| 3193 matrices of leaf window agree with their frame matrices about | |
| 3194 glyph pointers. */ | |
| 314 | 3195 |
| 21514 | 3196 void |
| 25012 | 3197 check_window_matrix_pointers (w) |
| 314 | 3198 struct window *w; |
| 3199 { | |
| 25012 | 3200 while (w) |
| 3201 { | |
| 3202 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) | |
| 3203 check_window_matrix_pointers (XWINDOW (w->hchild)); | |
| 3204 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) | |
| 3205 check_window_matrix_pointers (XWINDOW (w->vchild)); | |
| 3206 else | |
| 3207 { | |
| 3208 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame); | |
| 3209 check_matrix_pointers (w->desired_matrix, f->desired_matrix); | |
| 3210 check_matrix_pointers (w->current_matrix, f->current_matrix); | |
| 3211 } | |
| 3212 | |
| 3213 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); | |
| 3214 } | |
| 3215 } | |
| 3216 | |
| 3217 | |
| 3218 /* Check that window rows are slices of frame rows. WINDOW_MATRIX is | |
| 3219 a window and FRAME_MATRIX is the corresponding frame matrix. For | |
| 3220 each row in WINDOW_MATRIX check that it's a slice of the | |
| 3221 corresponding frame row. If it isn't, abort. */ | |
| 3222 | |
| 3223 static void | |
| 3224 check_matrix_pointers (window_matrix, frame_matrix) | |
| 3225 struct glyph_matrix *window_matrix, *frame_matrix; | |
| 3226 { | |
| 3227 /* Row number in WINDOW_MATRIX. */ | |
| 3228 int i = 0; | |
| 3229 | |
| 3230 /* Row number corresponding to I in FRAME_MATRIX. */ | |
| 3231 int j = window_matrix->matrix_y; | |
| 3232 | |
| 3233 /* For all rows check that the row in the window matrix is a | |
| 3234 slice of the row in the frame matrix. If it isn't we didn't | |
| 3235 mirror an operation on the frame matrix correctly. */ | |
| 3236 while (i < window_matrix->nrows) | |
| 3237 { | |
| 3238 if (!glyph_row_slice_p (window_matrix->rows + i, | |
| 3239 frame_matrix->rows + j)) | |
| 3240 abort (); | |
| 3241 ++i, ++j; | |
| 3242 } | |
| 3243 } | |
| 3244 | |
| 3245 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */ | |
| 3246 | |
| 3247 | |
| 3248 | |
| 3249 /********************************************************************** | |
| 3250 VPOS and HPOS translations | |
| 3251 **********************************************************************/ | |
| 3252 | |
| 3253 #if GLYPH_DEBUG | |
| 3254 | |
| 3255 /* Translate vertical position VPOS which is relative to window W to a | |
| 3256 vertical position relative to W's frame. */ | |
| 3257 | |
| 3258 static int | |
| 3259 window_to_frame_vpos (w, vpos) | |
| 3260 struct window *w; | |
| 3261 int vpos; | |
| 3262 { | |
| 3263 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame); | |
| 3264 | |
| 3265 xassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)); | |
| 3266 xassert (vpos >= 0 && vpos <= w->desired_matrix->nrows); | |
| 3267 vpos += XFASTINT (w->top); | |
| 3268 xassert (vpos >= 0 && vpos <= FRAME_HEIGHT (f)); | |
| 3269 return vpos; | |
| 3270 } | |
| 3271 | |
| 3272 | |
| 3273 /* Translate horizontal position HPOS which is relative to window W to | |
|
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
3274 a horizontal position relative to W's frame. */ |
| 25012 | 3275 |
| 3276 static int | |
| 3277 window_to_frame_hpos (w, hpos) | |
| 3278 struct window *w; | |
| 3279 int hpos; | |
| 3280 { | |
| 3281 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame); | |
| 3282 | |
| 3283 xassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)); | |
| 3284 hpos += XFASTINT (w->left); | |
| 3285 return hpos; | |
| 314 | 3286 } |
| 25012 | 3287 |
| 3288 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */ | |
| 3289 | |
| 3290 | |
| 314 | 3291 |
| 25012 | 3292 /********************************************************************** |
| 3293 Redrawing Frames | |
| 3294 **********************************************************************/ | |
| 3295 | |
| 3296 DEFUN ("redraw-frame", Fredraw_frame, Sredraw_frame, 1, 1, 0, | |
|
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
3297 doc: /* Clear frame FRAME and output again what is supposed to appear on it. */) |
|
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
3298 (frame) |
| 25012 | 3299 Lisp_Object frame; |
| 3300 { | |
| 3301 struct frame *f; | |
| 3302 | |
|
40656
cdfd4d09b79a
Update usage of CHECK_ macros (remove unused second argument).
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
40512
diff
changeset
|
3303 CHECK_LIVE_FRAME (frame); |
| 25012 | 3304 f = XFRAME (frame); |
| 3305 | |
| 3306 /* Ignore redraw requests, if frame has no glyphs yet. | |
| 3307 (Implementation note: It still has to be checked why we are | |
| 3308 called so early here). */ | |
| 3309 if (!glyphs_initialized_initially_p) | |
| 3310 return Qnil; | |
| 3311 | |
| 3312 update_begin (f); | |
|
35445
9af454aee182
(Fredraw_frame): Remove reference to
Andrew Innes <andrewi@gnu.org>
parents:
35374
diff
changeset
|
3313 if (FRAME_MSDOS_P (f)) |
| 25012 | 3314 set_terminal_modes (); |
| 3315 clear_frame (); | |
| 3316 clear_current_matrices (f); | |
| 3317 update_end (f); | |
| 3318 fflush (stdout); | |
| 3319 windows_or_buffers_changed++; | |
| 3320 /* Mark all windows as inaccurate, so that every window will have | |
| 3321 its redisplay done. */ | |
| 3322 mark_window_display_accurate (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f), 0); | |
| 3323 set_window_update_flags (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)), 1); | |
| 3324 f->garbaged = 0; | |
| 3325 return Qnil; | |
| 3326 } | |
| 3327 | |
| 3328 | |
| 3329 /* Redraw frame F. This is nothing more than a call to the Lisp | |
| 3330 function redraw-frame. */ | |
| 3331 | |
| 3332 void | |
| 3333 redraw_frame (f) | |
| 3334 struct frame *f; | |
| 3335 { | |
| 3336 Lisp_Object frame; | |
| 3337 XSETFRAME (frame, f); | |
| 3338 Fredraw_frame (frame); | |
| 3339 } | |
| 3340 | |
| 3341 | |
| 3342 DEFUN ("redraw-display", Fredraw_display, Sredraw_display, 0, 0, "", | |
|
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
3343 doc: /* Clear and redisplay all visible frames. */) |
|
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
3344 () |
| 25012 | 3345 { |
| 3346 Lisp_Object tail, frame; | |
| 3347 | |
| 3348 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame) | |
| 3349 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (XFRAME (frame))) | |
| 3350 Fredraw_frame (frame); | |
| 3351 | |
| 3352 return Qnil; | |
| 3353 } | |
| 3354 | |
| 3355 | |
| 3356 /* This is used when frame_garbaged is set. Call Fredraw_frame on all | |
| 3357 visible frames marked as garbaged. */ | |
| 3358 | |
| 3359 void | |
| 3360 redraw_garbaged_frames () | |
| 3361 { | |
| 3362 Lisp_Object tail, frame; | |
| 3363 | |
| 3364 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame) | |
| 3365 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (XFRAME (frame)) | |
| 3366 && FRAME_GARBAGED_P (XFRAME (frame))) | |
| 3367 Fredraw_frame (frame); | |
| 3368 } | |
| 3369 | |
| 3370 | |
| 3371 | |
| 3372 /*********************************************************************** | |
| 3373 Direct Operations | |
| 3374 ***********************************************************************/ | |
| 3375 | |
| 3376 /* Try to update display and current glyph matrix directly. | |
| 3377 | |
| 3378 This function is called after a character G has been inserted into | |
| 3379 current_buffer. It tries to update the current glyph matrix and | |
| 3380 perform appropriate screen output to reflect the insertion. If it | |
| 3381 succeeds, the global flag redisplay_performed_directly_p will be | |
| 3382 set to 1, and thereby prevent the more costly general redisplay | |
| 3383 from running (see redisplay_internal). | |
| 3384 | |
| 3385 This function is not called for `hairy' character insertions. | |
| 3386 In particular, it is not called when after or before change | |
| 3387 functions exist, like they are used by font-lock. See keyboard.c | |
| 3388 for details where this function is called. */ | |
| 314 | 3389 |
| 3390 int | |
| 3391 direct_output_for_insert (g) | |
| 3392 int g; | |
| 3393 { | |
|
25666
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
3394 register struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME (); |
| 25012 | 3395 struct window *w = XWINDOW (selected_window); |
| 3396 struct it it, it2; | |
| 3397 struct glyph_row *glyph_row; | |
| 3398 struct glyph *glyphs, *glyph, *end; | |
| 3399 int n; | |
|
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
3400 /* Non-null means that redisplay of W is based on window matrices. */ |
| 25012 | 3401 int window_redisplay_p = FRAME_WINDOW_P (f); |
| 3402 /* Non-null means we are in overwrite mode. */ | |
| 3403 int overwrite_p = !NILP (current_buffer->overwrite_mode); | |
| 3404 int added_width; | |
| 3405 struct text_pos pos; | |
| 3406 int delta, delta_bytes; | |
| 3407 | |
| 3408 /* Not done directly. */ | |
| 3409 redisplay_performed_directly_p = 0; | |
| 3410 | |
| 3411 /* Quickly give up for some common cases. */ | |
| 3412 if (cursor_in_echo_area | |
| 3413 /* Give up if fonts have changed. */ | |
| 3414 || fonts_changed_p | |
| 3415 /* Give up if face attributes have been changed. */ | |
| 3416 || face_change_count | |
| 3417 /* Give up if cursor position not really known. */ | |
| 314 | 3418 || !display_completed |
| 25012 | 3419 /* Give up if buffer appears in two places. */ |
| 314 | 3420 || buffer_shared > 1 |
|
34715
fc3693bea815
(direct_output_for_insert): Fix check for mini-window
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34622
diff
changeset
|
3421 /* Give up if currently displaying a message instead of the |
|
fc3693bea815
(direct_output_for_insert): Fix check for mini-window
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34622
diff
changeset
|
3422 minibuffer contents. */ |
|
fc3693bea815
(direct_output_for_insert): Fix check for mini-window
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34622
diff
changeset
|
3423 || (EQ (selected_window, minibuf_window) |
|
fc3693bea815
(direct_output_for_insert): Fix check for mini-window
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34622
diff
changeset
|
3424 && EQ (minibuf_window, echo_area_window)) |
| 25012 | 3425 /* Give up for hscrolled mini-buffer because display of the prompt |
| 3426 is handled specially there (see display_line). */ | |
| 3427 || (MINI_WINDOW_P (w) && XFASTINT (w->hscroll)) | |
| 3428 /* Give up if overwriting in the middle of a line. */ | |
| 3429 || (overwrite_p | |
| 3430 && PT != ZV | |
| 3431 && FETCH_BYTE (PT) != '\n') | |
| 3432 /* Give up for tabs and line ends. */ | |
| 3433 || g == '\t' | |
| 3434 || g == '\n' | |
| 3435 || g == '\r' | |
| 3436 /* Give up if unable to display the cursor in the window. */ | |
| 3437 || w->cursor.vpos < 0 | |
|
36279
1e3dc8692936
(direct_output_for_insert): Give up if we are showing
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36115
diff
changeset
|
3438 /* Give up if we are showing a message or just cleared the message |
|
1e3dc8692936
(direct_output_for_insert): Give up if we are showing
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36115
diff
changeset
|
3439 because we might need to resize the echo area window. */ |
|
1e3dc8692936
(direct_output_for_insert): Give up if we are showing
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36115
diff
changeset
|
3440 || !NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]) |
|
1e3dc8692936
(direct_output_for_insert): Give up if we are showing
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36115
diff
changeset
|
3441 || !NILP (echo_area_buffer[1]) |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3442 || (glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos), |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3443 /* Can't do it in a continued line because continuation |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3444 lines would change. */ |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3445 (glyph_row->continued_p |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3446 /* Can't use this method if the line overlaps others or is |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3447 overlapped by others because these other lines would |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3448 have to be redisplayed. */ |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3449 || glyph_row->overlapping_p |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3450 || glyph_row->overlapped_p)) |
| 25012 | 3451 /* Can't do it for partial width windows on terminal frames |
| 3452 because we can't clear to eol in such a window. */ | |
| 3453 || (!window_redisplay_p && !WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w))) | |
| 3454 return 0; | |
| 3455 | |
|
35374
3fc8f4c6ed56
(direct_output_for_insert): If char_ins_del_ok is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35336
diff
changeset
|
3456 /* If we can't insert glyphs, we can use this method only |
|
3fc8f4c6ed56
(direct_output_for_insert): If char_ins_del_ok is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35336
diff
changeset
|
3457 at the end of a line. */ |
|
3fc8f4c6ed56
(direct_output_for_insert): If char_ins_del_ok is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35336
diff
changeset
|
3458 if (!char_ins_del_ok) |
|
3fc8f4c6ed56
(direct_output_for_insert): If char_ins_del_ok is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35336
diff
changeset
|
3459 if (PT != ZV && FETCH_BYTE (PT_BYTE) != '\n') |
|
3fc8f4c6ed56
(direct_output_for_insert): If char_ins_del_ok is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35336
diff
changeset
|
3460 return 0; |
|
3fc8f4c6ed56
(direct_output_for_insert): If char_ins_del_ok is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35336
diff
changeset
|
3461 |
| 25012 | 3462 /* Set up a display iterator structure for W. Glyphs will be |
| 3463 produced in scratch_glyph_row. Current position is W's cursor | |
| 3464 position. */ | |
| 3465 clear_glyph_row (&scratch_glyph_row); | |
| 3466 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, PT, PT_BYTE); | |
|
28361
eccb57c44da5
(direct_output_for_insert): Use DEC_TEXT_POS
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27968
diff
changeset
|
3467 DEC_TEXT_POS (pos, !NILP (current_buffer->enable_multibyte_characters)); |
| 25012 | 3468 init_iterator (&it, w, CHARPOS (pos), BYTEPOS (pos), &scratch_glyph_row, |
| 3469 DEFAULT_FACE_ID); | |
| 3470 | |
| 3471 glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos); | |
|
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
3472 if (glyph_row->mouse_face_p) |
|
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
3473 return 0; |
| 25012 | 3474 |
| 3475 /* Give up if highlighting trailing whitespace and we have trailing | |
| 3476 whitespace in glyph_row. We would have to remove the trailing | |
| 3477 whitespace face in that case. */ | |
|
25304
4b75c26bd356
(direct_output_for_insert): Use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25241
diff
changeset
|
3478 if (!NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace) |
| 25012 | 3479 && glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA]) |
| 3480 { | |
| 3481 struct glyph *last; | |
| 3482 | |
| 3483 last = glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1; | |
| 3484 if (last->type == STRETCH_GLYPH | |
| 3485 || (last->type == CHAR_GLYPH | |
|
26998
02e902f732d1
(line_hash_code) (direct_output_for_insert): Adjusted
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
26902
diff
changeset
|
3486 && last->u.ch == ' ')) |
| 25012 | 3487 return 0; |
| 3488 } | |
| 3489 | |
| 3490 /* Give up if there are overlay strings at pos. This would fail | |
| 3491 if the overlay string has newlines in it. */ | |
| 3492 if (STRINGP (it.string)) | |
| 3493 return 0; | |
| 3494 | |
| 3495 it.hpos = w->cursor.hpos; | |
| 3496 it.vpos = w->cursor.vpos; | |
| 3497 it.current_x = w->cursor.x + it.first_visible_x; | |
| 3498 it.current_y = w->cursor.y; | |
| 3499 it.end_charpos = PT; | |
| 3500 it.stop_charpos = min (PT, it.stop_charpos); | |
|
39226
d86fe98ee7d5
(direct_output_for_insert): Don't change IT's
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38988
diff
changeset
|
3501 it.stop_charpos = max (IT_CHARPOS (it), it.stop_charpos); |
| 25012 | 3502 |
| 3503 /* More than one display element may be returned for PT - 1 if | |
| 3504 (i) it's a control character which is translated into `\003' or | |
| 3505 `^C', or (ii) it has a display table entry, or (iii) it's a | |
| 3506 combination of both. */ | |
| 3507 delta = delta_bytes = 0; | |
| 3508 while (get_next_display_element (&it)) | |
| 3509 { | |
| 3510 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&it); | |
| 3511 | |
| 3512 /* Give up if glyph doesn't fit completely on the line. */ | |
| 3513 if (it.current_x >= it.last_visible_x) | |
| 3514 return 0; | |
| 3515 | |
| 3516 /* Give up if new glyph has different ascent or descent than | |
| 3517 the original row, or if it is not a character glyph. */ | |
| 3518 if (glyph_row->ascent != it.ascent | |
| 3519 || glyph_row->height != it.ascent + it.descent | |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3520 || glyph_row->phys_ascent != it.phys_ascent |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3521 || glyph_row->phys_height != it.phys_ascent + it.phys_descent |
| 25012 | 3522 || it.what != IT_CHARACTER) |
| 3523 return 0; | |
| 3524 | |
| 3525 delta += 1; | |
| 3526 delta_bytes += it.len; | |
|
32468
20788c8274cd
(direct_output_for_insert): Call set_iterator_to_next
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31932
diff
changeset
|
3527 set_iterator_to_next (&it, 1); |
| 25012 | 3528 } |
| 3529 | |
| 3530 /* Give up if we hit the right edge of the window. We would have | |
| 3531 to insert truncation or continuation glyphs. */ | |
| 3532 added_width = it.current_x - (w->cursor.x + it.first_visible_x); | |
| 3533 if (glyph_row->pixel_width + added_width >= it.last_visible_x) | |
| 314 | 3534 return 0; |
| 3535 | |
| 25012 | 3536 /* Give up if there is a \t following in the line. */ |
| 3537 it2 = it; | |
| 3538 it2.end_charpos = ZV; | |
| 3539 it2.stop_charpos = min (it2.stop_charpos, ZV); | |
| 3540 while (get_next_display_element (&it2) | |
| 3541 && !ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (&it2)) | |
| 3542 { | |
| 3543 if (it2.c == '\t') | |
| 3544 return 0; | |
|
32468
20788c8274cd
(direct_output_for_insert): Call set_iterator_to_next
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31932
diff
changeset
|
3545 set_iterator_to_next (&it2, 1); |
| 25012 | 3546 } |
| 3547 | |
| 3548 /* Number of new glyphs produced. */ | |
| 3549 n = it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA]; | |
| 3550 | |
| 3551 /* Start and end of glyphs in original row. */ | |
| 3552 glyphs = glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + w->cursor.hpos; | |
| 3553 end = glyph_row->glyphs[1 + TEXT_AREA]; | |
| 3554 | |
| 3555 /* Make room for new glyphs, then insert them. */ | |
| 3556 xassert (end - glyphs - n >= 0); | |
|
25781
e5579bc77d9e
(direct_output_for_insert): Cast arguments to
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25735
diff
changeset
|
3557 safe_bcopy ((char *) glyphs, (char *) (glyphs + n), |
|
e5579bc77d9e
(direct_output_for_insert): Cast arguments to
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25735
diff
changeset
|
3558 (end - glyphs - n) * sizeof (*end)); |
| 25012 | 3559 bcopy (it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], glyphs, n * sizeof *glyphs); |
| 3560 glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = min (glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] + n, | |
| 3561 end - glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]); | |
| 3562 | |
| 3563 /* Compute new line width. */ | |
| 3564 glyph = glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; | |
| 3565 end = glyph + glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA]; | |
| 3566 glyph_row->pixel_width = glyph_row->x; | |
| 3567 while (glyph < end) | |
| 3568 { | |
| 3569 glyph_row->pixel_width += glyph->pixel_width; | |
| 3570 ++glyph; | |
| 3571 } | |
| 3572 | |
| 3573 /* Increment buffer positions for glyphs following the newly | |
| 3574 inserted ones. */ | |
| 3575 for (glyph = glyphs + n; glyph < end; ++glyph) | |
|
26546
0f43cc91d6a5
(direct_output_for_insert): Increment glyph positions
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26499
diff
changeset
|
3576 if (glyph->charpos > 0 && BUFFERP (glyph->object)) |
| 25012 | 3577 glyph->charpos += delta; |
| 3578 | |
| 3579 if (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (glyph_row) > 0) | |
| 3580 { | |
| 3581 MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (glyph_row) += delta; | |
| 3582 MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (glyph_row) += delta_bytes; | |
| 3583 } | |
| 3584 | |
| 3585 /* Adjust positions in lines following the one we are in. */ | |
|
28708
4e2497e6757e
(increment_matrix_positions): Renamed from
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28682
diff
changeset
|
3586 increment_matrix_positions (w->current_matrix, |
|
4e2497e6757e
(increment_matrix_positions): Renamed from
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28682
diff
changeset
|
3587 w->cursor.vpos + 1, |
|
4e2497e6757e
(increment_matrix_positions): Renamed from
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28682
diff
changeset
|
3588 w->current_matrix->nrows, |
|
4e2497e6757e
(increment_matrix_positions): Renamed from
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28682
diff
changeset
|
3589 delta, delta_bytes); |
| 25012 | 3590 |
| 3591 glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p | |
| 3592 |= it.glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p; | |
| 3593 | |
|
26591
f7c7ef351f04
(direct_output_for_insert): Set glyph row's
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26546
diff
changeset
|
3594 glyph_row->displays_text_p = 1; |
|
f7c7ef351f04
(direct_output_for_insert): Set glyph row's
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26546
diff
changeset
|
3595 w->window_end_vpos = make_number (max (w->cursor.vpos, |
|
f7c7ef351f04
(direct_output_for_insert): Set glyph row's
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26546
diff
changeset
|
3596 XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos))); |
|
f7c7ef351f04
(direct_output_for_insert): Set glyph row's
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26546
diff
changeset
|
3597 |
|
25304
4b75c26bd356
(direct_output_for_insert): Use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25241
diff
changeset
|
3598 if (!NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace)) |
| 25012 | 3599 highlight_trailing_whitespace (it.f, glyph_row); |
| 3600 | |
| 3601 /* Write glyphs. If at end of row, we can simply call write_glyphs. | |
| 3602 In the middle, we have to insert glyphs. Note that this is now | |
| 3603 implemented for X frames. The implementation uses updated_window | |
| 3604 and updated_row. */ | |
| 3605 updated_row = glyph_row; | |
|
38988
53ae5a92e2fc
(direct_output_for_insert): Set updated_area
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38748
diff
changeset
|
3606 updated_area = TEXT_AREA; |
| 25012 | 3607 update_begin (f); |
| 3608 if (rif) | |
| 3609 { | |
| 3610 rif->update_window_begin_hook (w); | |
| 3611 | |
|
36115
c0fac212cfcc
(direct_output_for_insert): Recognize more cases where
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36097
diff
changeset
|
3612 if (glyphs == end - n |
|
c0fac212cfcc
(direct_output_for_insert): Recognize more cases where
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36097
diff
changeset
|
3613 /* In front of a space added by append_space. */ |
|
c0fac212cfcc
(direct_output_for_insert): Recognize more cases where
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36097
diff
changeset
|
3614 || (glyphs == end - n - 1 |
|
c0fac212cfcc
(direct_output_for_insert): Recognize more cases where
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36097
diff
changeset
|
3615 && (end - n)->charpos <= 0)) |
| 25012 | 3616 rif->write_glyphs (glyphs, n); |
| 3617 else | |
| 3618 rif->insert_glyphs (glyphs, n); | |
| 3619 } | |
| 3620 else | |
| 3621 { | |
| 3622 if (glyphs == end - n) | |
| 3623 write_glyphs (glyphs, n); | |
| 3624 else | |
| 3625 insert_glyphs (glyphs, n); | |
| 3626 } | |
| 3627 | |
| 3628 w->cursor.hpos += n; | |
| 3629 w->cursor.x = it.current_x - it.first_visible_x; | |
| 3630 xassert (w->cursor.hpos >= 0 | |
| 3631 && w->cursor.hpos < w->desired_matrix->matrix_w); | |
| 3632 | |
| 3633 /* How to set the cursor differs depending on whether we are | |
| 3634 using a frame matrix or a window matrix. Note that when | |
| 3635 a frame matrix is used, cursor_to expects frame coordinates, | |
| 3636 and the X and Y parameters are not used. */ | |
| 3637 if (window_redisplay_p) | |
| 3638 rif->cursor_to (w->cursor.vpos, w->cursor.hpos, | |
| 3639 w->cursor.y, w->cursor.x); | |
| 3640 else | |
| 3641 { | |
| 3642 int x, y; | |
| 3643 x = (WINDOW_TO_FRAME_HPOS (w, w->cursor.hpos) | |
| 3644 + (INTEGERP (w->left_margin_width) | |
| 3645 ? XFASTINT (w->left_margin_width) | |
| 3646 : 0)); | |
| 3647 y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_VPOS (w, w->cursor.vpos); | |
| 3648 cursor_to (y, x); | |
| 3649 } | |
| 3650 | |
| 3651 if (rif) | |
|
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
3652 rif->update_window_end_hook (w, 1, 0); |
| 25012 | 3653 update_end (f); |
| 3654 updated_row = NULL; | |
| 3655 fflush (stdout); | |
| 3656 | |
| 3657 TRACE ((stderr, "direct output for insert\n")); | |
| 3658 | |
|
25372
acf281b41a38
(direct_output_for_insert): Set beg_unchanged
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25345
diff
changeset
|
3659 UNCHANGED_MODIFIED = MODIFF; |
|
acf281b41a38
(direct_output_for_insert): Set beg_unchanged
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25345
diff
changeset
|
3660 BEG_UNCHANGED = GPT - BEG; |
|
16039
855c8d8ba0f0
Change all references from point to PT.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
15896
diff
changeset
|
3661 XSETFASTINT (w->last_point, PT); |
| 25012 | 3662 w->last_cursor = w->cursor; |
|
9303
3115ae493c30
(direct_output_for_insert, direct_output_forward_char, change_frame_size,
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
9264
diff
changeset
|
3663 XSETFASTINT (w->last_modified, MODIFF); |
|
16195
e15e4bdcb8cc
(direct_output_for_insert): Set last_overlay_modified field in window.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16051
diff
changeset
|
3664 XSETFASTINT (w->last_overlay_modified, OVERLAY_MODIFF); |
| 314 | 3665 |
| 25012 | 3666 redisplay_performed_directly_p = 1; |
| 314 | 3667 return 1; |
| 3668 } | |
| 3669 | |
| 25012 | 3670 |
| 3671 /* Perform a direct display update for moving PT by N positions | |
| 3672 left or right. N < 0 means a movement backwards. This function | |
| 3673 is currently only called for N == 1 or N == -1. */ | |
| 3674 | |
| 314 | 3675 int |
| 3676 direct_output_forward_char (n) | |
| 3677 int n; | |
| 3678 { | |
|
25666
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
3679 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME (); |
| 25012 | 3680 struct window *w = XWINDOW (selected_window); |
| 3681 struct glyph_row *row; | |
| 3682 | |
|
26851
2513566d55fd
(direct_output_forward_char): Check point moving into
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
26729
diff
changeset
|
3683 /* Give up if point moved out of or into a composition. */ |
|
28507
b6f06a755c7d
make_number/XINT/XUINT conversions; EQ/== fixes; ==Qnil -> NILP
Ken Raeburn <raeburn@raeburn.org>
parents:
28361
diff
changeset
|
3684 if (check_point_in_composition (current_buffer, XINT (w->last_point), |
|
26851
2513566d55fd
(direct_output_forward_char): Check point moving into
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
26729
diff
changeset
|
3685 current_buffer, PT)) |
|
2513566d55fd
(direct_output_forward_char): Check point moving into
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
26729
diff
changeset
|
3686 return 0; |
|
2513566d55fd
(direct_output_forward_char): Check point moving into
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
26729
diff
changeset
|
3687 |
| 25012 | 3688 /* Give up if face attributes have been changed. */ |
| 3689 if (face_change_count) | |
|
17015
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
3690 return 0; |
| 25012 | 3691 |
| 3692 /* Give up if current matrix is not up to date or we are | |
| 3693 displaying a message. */ | |
| 3694 if (!display_completed || cursor_in_echo_area) | |
| 3695 return 0; | |
| 3696 | |
| 3697 /* Give up if the buffer's direction is reversed. */ | |
| 3698 if (!NILP (XBUFFER (w->buffer)->direction_reversed)) | |
| 314 | 3699 return 0; |
|
11096
cac0367b1794
(direct_output_forward_char): Don't use direct output at an overlay boundary.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
10770
diff
changeset
|
3700 |
|
2794
9163e4e4752c
(direct_output_forward_char): Just give up
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
2778
diff
changeset
|
3701 /* Can't use direct output if highlighting a region. */ |
|
9163e4e4752c
(direct_output_forward_char): Just give up
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
2778
diff
changeset
|
3702 if (!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode) && !NILP (current_buffer->mark_active)) |
|
9163e4e4752c
(direct_output_forward_char): Just give up
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
2778
diff
changeset
|
3703 return 0; |
|
9163e4e4752c
(direct_output_forward_char): Just give up
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
2778
diff
changeset
|
3704 |
|
25304
4b75c26bd356
(direct_output_for_insert): Use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25241
diff
changeset
|
3705 /* Can't use direct output if highlighting trailing whitespace. */ |
|
4b75c26bd356
(direct_output_for_insert): Use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25241
diff
changeset
|
3706 if (!NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace)) |
|
4b75c26bd356
(direct_output_for_insert): Use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25241
diff
changeset
|
3707 return 0; |
|
4b75c26bd356
(direct_output_for_insert): Use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25241
diff
changeset
|
3708 |
|
25735
fcb92c26acf2
(direct_output_forward_char): Don't use this method
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25725
diff
changeset
|
3709 /* Give up if we are showing a message or just cleared the message |
|
fcb92c26acf2
(direct_output_forward_char): Don't use this method
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25725
diff
changeset
|
3710 because we might need to resize the echo area window. */ |
|
fcb92c26acf2
(direct_output_forward_char): Don't use this method
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25725
diff
changeset
|
3711 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]) || !NILP (echo_area_buffer[1])) |
|
fcb92c26acf2
(direct_output_forward_char): Don't use this method
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25725
diff
changeset
|
3712 return 0; |
|
fcb92c26acf2
(direct_output_forward_char): Don't use this method
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25725
diff
changeset
|
3713 |
|
30152
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
3714 /* Give up if currently displaying a message instead of the |
|
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
3715 minibuffer contents. */ |
|
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
3716 if (XWINDOW (minibuf_window) == w |
|
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
3717 && EQ (minibuf_window, echo_area_window)) |
|
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
3718 return 0; |
|
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
3719 |
|
25735
fcb92c26acf2
(direct_output_forward_char): Don't use this method
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25725
diff
changeset
|
3720 /* Give up if we don't know where the cursor is. */ |
|
fcb92c26acf2
(direct_output_forward_char): Don't use this method
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25725
diff
changeset
|
3721 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0) |
|
fcb92c26acf2
(direct_output_forward_char): Don't use this method
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25725
diff
changeset
|
3722 return 0; |
|
fcb92c26acf2
(direct_output_forward_char): Don't use this method
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25725
diff
changeset
|
3723 |
| 25012 | 3724 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos); |
| 3725 | |
|
31271
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
3726 /* Give up if PT is outside of the last known cursor row. */ |
|
41069
818a84568f83
(direct_output_forward_char): Fix character/byte
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
41025
diff
changeset
|
3727 if (PT <= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) |
|
818a84568f83
(direct_output_forward_char): Fix character/byte
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
41025
diff
changeset
|
3728 || PT >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)) |
|
6069
07045ca8ff19
(direct_output_forward_char): Use Fget_char_property to test for invisibility.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
6068
diff
changeset
|
3729 return 0; |
|
4384
98605d0ea3cf
(direct_output_for_insert): Fail if character
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
4290
diff
changeset
|
3730 |
| 25012 | 3731 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0); |
|
31271
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
3732 |
| 25012 | 3733 w->last_cursor = w->cursor; |
|
16039
855c8d8ba0f0
Change all references from point to PT.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
15896
diff
changeset
|
3734 XSETFASTINT (w->last_point, PT); |
| 25012 | 3735 |
| 3736 xassert (w->cursor.hpos >= 0 | |
| 3737 && w->cursor.hpos < w->desired_matrix->matrix_w); | |
| 3738 | |
| 3739 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)) | |
| 3740 rif->cursor_to (w->cursor.vpos, w->cursor.hpos, | |
| 3741 w->cursor.y, w->cursor.x); | |
| 3742 else | |
| 3743 { | |
| 3744 int x, y; | |
| 3745 x = (WINDOW_TO_FRAME_HPOS (w, w->cursor.hpos) | |
| 3746 + (INTEGERP (w->left_margin_width) | |
| 3747 ? XFASTINT (w->left_margin_width) | |
| 3748 : 0)); | |
| 3749 y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_VPOS (w, w->cursor.vpos); | |
| 3750 cursor_to (y, x); | |
| 3751 } | |
| 3752 | |
| 314 | 3753 fflush (stdout); |
| 25012 | 3754 redisplay_performed_directly_p = 1; |
| 314 | 3755 return 1; |
| 3756 } | |
| 25012 | 3757 |
| 3758 | |
| 314 | 3759 |
| 25012 | 3760 /*********************************************************************** |
| 3761 Frame Update | |
| 3762 ***********************************************************************/ | |
| 3763 | |
| 3764 /* Update frame F based on the data in desired matrices. | |
| 3765 | |
| 3766 If FORCE_P is non-zero, don't let redisplay be stopped by detecting | |
| 3767 pending input. If INHIBIT_HAIRY_ID_P is non-zero, don't try | |
| 3768 scrolling. | |
| 3769 | |
| 3770 Value is non-zero if redisplay was stopped due to pending input. */ | |
| 314 | 3771 |
| 3772 int | |
| 25012 | 3773 update_frame (f, force_p, inhibit_hairy_id_p) |
| 3774 struct frame *f; | |
| 3775 int force_p; | |
| 3776 int inhibit_hairy_id_p; | |
| 3777 { | |
| 3778 /* 1 means display has been paused because of pending input. */ | |
| 3779 int paused_p; | |
| 3780 struct window *root_window = XWINDOW (f->root_window); | |
| 3781 | |
| 3782 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)) | |
| 3783 { | |
| 3784 /* We are working on window matrix basis. All windows whose | |
| 3785 flag must_be_updated_p is set have to be updated. */ | |
| 3786 | |
| 3787 /* Record that we are not working on frame matrices. */ | |
| 3788 set_frame_matrix_frame (NULL); | |
| 3789 | |
| 3790 /* Update all windows in the window tree of F, maybe stopping | |
| 3791 when pending input is detected. */ | |
| 3792 update_begin (f); | |
| 3793 | |
| 3794 /* Update the menu bar on X frames that don't have toolkit | |
| 3795 support. */ | |
| 3796 if (WINDOWP (f->menu_bar_window)) | |
| 3797 update_window (XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window), 1); | |
| 3798 | |
| 3799 /* Update the tool-bar window, if present. */ | |
|
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
3800 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)) |
| 25012 | 3801 { |
|
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
3802 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window); |
| 25012 | 3803 |
| 3804 /* Update tool-bar window. */ | |
| 3805 if (w->must_be_updated_p) | |
| 3806 { | |
|
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
3807 Lisp_Object tem; |
|
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
3808 |
| 25012 | 3809 update_window (w, 1); |
| 3810 w->must_be_updated_p = 0; | |
| 3811 | |
| 3812 /* Swap tool-bar strings. We swap because we want to | |
| 3813 reuse strings. */ | |
|
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
3814 tem = f->current_tool_bar_string; |
|
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
3815 f->current_tool_bar_string = f->desired_tool_bar_string; |
|
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
3816 f->desired_tool_bar_string = tem; |
| 25012 | 3817 } |
| 3818 } | |
| 3819 | |
| 3820 | |
| 3821 /* Update windows. */ | |
| 3822 paused_p = update_window_tree (root_window, force_p); | |
| 3823 update_end (f); | |
|
31295
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3824 |
|
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3825 #if 0 /* This flush is a performance bottleneck under X, |
|
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3826 and it doesn't seem to be necessary anyway. */ |
| 25012 | 3827 rif->flush_display (f); |
| 3828 #endif | |
| 3829 } | |
| 3830 else | |
| 3831 { | |
| 3832 /* We are working on frame matrix basis. Set the frame on whose | |
| 3833 frame matrix we operate. */ | |
| 3834 set_frame_matrix_frame (f); | |
| 3835 | |
|
31295
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3836 /* Build F's desired matrix from window matrices. */ |
| 25012 | 3837 build_frame_matrix (f); |
| 3838 | |
|
31295
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3839 /* Update the display */ |
|
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3840 update_begin (f); |
| 25012 | 3841 paused_p = update_frame_1 (f, force_p, inhibit_hairy_id_p); |
|
31295
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3842 update_end (f); |
|
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3843 |
|
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3844 if (termscript) |
|
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3845 fflush (termscript); |
|
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3846 fflush (stdout); |
|
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3847 |
| 25012 | 3848 /* Check window matrices for lost pointers. */ |
|
34893
779bd3fa820e
Use #if GLYPH_DEBUG instead of #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34866
diff
changeset
|
3849 #if GLYPH_DEBUG |
|
34866
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
3850 check_window_matrix_pointers (root_window); |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
3851 add_frame_display_history (f, paused_p); |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
3852 #endif |
| 25012 | 3853 } |
| 3854 | |
| 3855 /* Reset flags indicating that a window should be updated. */ | |
| 3856 set_window_update_flags (root_window, 0); | |
|
31295
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3857 |
|
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3858 display_completed = !paused_p; |
| 25012 | 3859 return paused_p; |
| 3860 } | |
| 3861 | |
| 3862 | |
| 3863 | |
| 3864 /************************************************************************ | |
| 3865 Window-based updates | |
| 3866 ************************************************************************/ | |
| 3867 | |
| 3868 /* Perform updates in window tree rooted at W. FORCE_P non-zero means | |
| 3869 don't stop updating when input is pending. */ | |
| 3870 | |
| 3871 static int | |
| 3872 update_window_tree (w, force_p) | |
| 3873 struct window *w; | |
| 3874 int force_p; | |
| 3875 { | |
| 3876 int paused_p = 0; | |
| 3877 | |
| 3878 while (w && !paused_p) | |
| 3879 { | |
| 3880 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) | |
| 3881 paused_p |= update_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->hchild), force_p); | |
| 3882 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) | |
| 3883 paused_p |= update_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->vchild), force_p); | |
| 3884 else if (w->must_be_updated_p) | |
| 3885 paused_p |= update_window (w, force_p); | |
| 3886 | |
| 3887 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); | |
| 3888 } | |
| 3889 | |
| 3890 return paused_p; | |
| 3891 } | |
| 3892 | |
| 3893 | |
| 3894 /* Update window W if its flag must_be_updated_p is non-zero. If | |
| 3895 FORCE_P is non-zero, don't stop updating if input is pending. */ | |
| 3896 | |
| 3897 void | |
| 3898 update_single_window (w, force_p) | |
| 3899 struct window *w; | |
| 3900 int force_p; | |
| 3901 { | |
| 3902 if (w->must_be_updated_p) | |
| 3903 { | |
| 3904 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w)); | |
| 3905 | |
| 3906 /* Record that this is not a frame-based redisplay. */ | |
| 3907 set_frame_matrix_frame (NULL); | |
| 3908 | |
| 3909 /* Update W. */ | |
| 3910 update_begin (f); | |
| 3911 update_window (w, force_p); | |
| 3912 update_end (f); | |
| 3913 | |
| 3914 /* Reset flag in W. */ | |
| 3915 w->must_be_updated_p = 0; | |
| 3916 } | |
| 3917 } | |
| 3918 | |
| 3919 | |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3920 /* Redraw lines from the current matrix of window W that are |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3921 overlapped by other rows. YB is bottom-most y-position in W. */ |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3922 |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3923 static void |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3924 redraw_overlapped_rows (w, yb) |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3925 struct window *w; |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3926 int yb; |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3927 { |
|
30165
d7ec5b3caccc
(redraw_overlapped_rows): Add missing local.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30161
diff
changeset
|
3928 int i; |
|
d7ec5b3caccc
(redraw_overlapped_rows): Add missing local.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30161
diff
changeset
|
3929 |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3930 /* If rows overlapping others have been changed, the rows being |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3931 overlapped have to be redrawn. This won't draw lines that have |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3932 already been drawn in update_window_line because overlapped_p in |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3933 desired rows is 0, so after row assignment overlapped_p in |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3934 current rows is 0. */ |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3935 for (i = 0; i < w->current_matrix->nrows; ++i) |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3936 { |
|
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
3937 struct glyph_row *row = w->current_matrix->rows + i; |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3938 |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3939 if (!row->enabled_p) |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3940 break; |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3941 else if (row->mode_line_p) |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3942 continue; |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3943 |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3944 if (row->overlapped_p) |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3945 { |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3946 enum glyph_row_area area; |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3947 |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3948 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area < LAST_AREA; ++area) |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3949 { |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3950 updated_row = row; |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3951 updated_area = area; |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3952 rif->cursor_to (i, 0, row->y, area == TEXT_AREA ? row->x : 0); |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3953 if (row->used[area]) |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3954 rif->write_glyphs (row->glyphs[area], row->used[area]); |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3955 rif->clear_end_of_line (-1); |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3956 } |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3957 |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3958 row->overlapped_p = 0; |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3959 } |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3960 |
|
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
3961 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= yb) |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3962 break; |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3963 } |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3964 } |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3965 |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3966 |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3967 /* Redraw lines from the current matrix of window W that overlap |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3968 others. YB is bottom-most y-position in W. */ |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3969 |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3970 static void |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3971 redraw_overlapping_rows (w, yb) |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3972 struct window *w; |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3973 int yb; |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3974 { |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3975 int i, bottom_y; |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3976 struct glyph_row *row; |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3977 |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3978 for (i = 0; i < w->current_matrix->nrows; ++i) |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3979 { |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3980 row = w->current_matrix->rows + i; |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3981 |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3982 if (!row->enabled_p) |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3983 break; |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3984 else if (row->mode_line_p) |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3985 continue; |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3986 |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3987 bottom_y = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row); |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3988 |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3989 if (row->overlapping_p && i > 0 && bottom_y < yb) |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3990 { |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3991 if (row->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA]) |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3992 rif->fix_overlapping_area (w, row, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA); |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3993 |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3994 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA]) |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3995 rif->fix_overlapping_area (w, row, TEXT_AREA); |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3996 |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3997 if (row->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA]) |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3998 rif->fix_overlapping_area (w, row, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA); |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3999 |
|
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
4000 /* Record in neighbour rows that ROW overwrites part of their |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4001 display. */ |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4002 if (row->phys_ascent > row->ascent && i > 0) |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4003 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i - 1)->overlapped_p = 1; |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4004 if ((row->phys_height - row->phys_ascent |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4005 > row->height - row->ascent) |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4006 && bottom_y < yb) |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4007 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i + 1)->overlapped_p = 1; |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4008 } |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4009 |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4010 if (bottom_y >= yb) |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4011 break; |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4012 } |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4013 } |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4014 |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4015 |
|
34929
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4016 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4017 |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4018 /* Check that no row in the current matrix of window W is enabled |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4019 which is below what's displayed in the window. */ |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4020 |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4021 void |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4022 check_current_matrix_flags (w) |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4023 struct window *w; |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4024 { |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4025 int last_seen_p = 0; |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4026 int i, yb = window_text_bottom_y (w); |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4027 |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4028 for (i = 0; i < w->current_matrix->nrows - 1; ++i) |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4029 { |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4030 struct glyph_row *row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i); |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4031 if (!last_seen_p && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= yb) |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4032 last_seen_p = 1; |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4033 else if (last_seen_p && row->enabled_p) |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4034 abort (); |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4035 } |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4036 } |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4037 |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4038 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */ |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4039 |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4040 |
| 25012 | 4041 /* Update display of window W. FORCE_P non-zero means that we should |
| 4042 not stop when detecting pending input. */ | |
| 4043 | |
| 4044 static int | |
| 4045 update_window (w, force_p) | |
| 4046 struct window *w; | |
| 4047 int force_p; | |
| 4048 { | |
| 4049 struct glyph_matrix *desired_matrix = w->desired_matrix; | |
| 4050 int paused_p; | |
| 4051 int preempt_count = baud_rate / 2400 + 1; | |
| 4052 extern int input_pending; | |
|
34517
7c8d2cec3d08
(update_window): If do_mouse_tracking is non-nil,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34279
diff
changeset
|
4053 extern Lisp_Object do_mouse_tracking; |
|
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4054 #if GLYPH_DEBUG |
|
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4055 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w)); |
| 25012 | 4056 extern struct frame *updating_frame; |
|
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4057 #endif |
| 25012 | 4058 |
| 4059 /* Check that W's frame doesn't have glyph matrices. */ | |
| 4060 xassert (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)); | |
| 4061 xassert (updating_frame != NULL); | |
| 4062 | |
| 4063 /* Check pending input the first time so that we can quickly return. */ | |
| 4064 if (redisplay_dont_pause) | |
| 4065 force_p = 1; | |
| 4066 else | |
| 4067 detect_input_pending (); | |
| 4068 | |
| 4069 /* If forced to complete the update, or if no input is pending, do | |
| 4070 the update. */ | |
|
34517
7c8d2cec3d08
(update_window): If do_mouse_tracking is non-nil,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34279
diff
changeset
|
4071 if (force_p || !input_pending || !NILP (do_mouse_tracking)) |
| 25012 | 4072 { |
| 4073 struct glyph_row *row, *end; | |
| 4074 struct glyph_row *mode_line_row; | |
|
38489
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4075 struct glyph_row *header_line_row; |
|
34622
877ed6cab304
(update_window): Detect pending input every nth line
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34517
diff
changeset
|
4076 int yb, changed_p = 0, mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0, n_updated; |
| 25012 | 4077 |
| 4078 rif->update_window_begin_hook (w); | |
| 4079 yb = window_text_bottom_y (w); | |
| 4080 | |
|
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
4081 /* If window has a header line, update it before everything else. |
|
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
4082 Adjust y-positions of other rows by the header line height. */ |
| 25012 | 4083 row = desired_matrix->rows; |
| 4084 end = row + desired_matrix->nrows - 1; | |
|
38489
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4085 |
| 25012 | 4086 if (row->mode_line_p) |
|
38489
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4087 { |
|
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4088 header_line_row = row; |
|
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4089 ++row; |
|
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4090 } |
|
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4091 else |
|
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4092 header_line_row = NULL; |
| 25012 | 4093 |
| 4094 /* Update the mode line, if necessary. */ | |
| 4095 mode_line_row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (desired_matrix); | |
| 4096 if (mode_line_row->mode_line_p && mode_line_row->enabled_p) | |
| 4097 { | |
| 4098 mode_line_row->y = yb; | |
| 4099 update_window_line (w, MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (mode_line_row, | |
|
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4100 desired_matrix), |
|
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4101 &mouse_face_overwritten_p); |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4102 changed_p = 1; |
| 25012 | 4103 } |
| 4104 | |
| 4105 /* Find first enabled row. Optimizations in redisplay_internal | |
| 4106 may lead to an update with only one row enabled. There may | |
| 4107 be also completely empty matrices. */ | |
| 4108 while (row < end && !row->enabled_p) | |
| 4109 ++row; | |
| 4110 | |
|
31825
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4111 /* Try reusing part of the display by copying. */ |
| 25012 | 4112 if (row < end && !desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p) |
|
38489
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4113 { |
|
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4114 int rc = scrolling_window (w, header_line_row != NULL); |
|
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4115 if (rc < 0) |
|
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4116 { |
|
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4117 /* All rows were found to be equal. */ |
|
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4118 paused_p = 0; |
|
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4119 goto set_cursor; |
|
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4120 } |
|
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4121 else if (rc > 0) |
|
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4122 /* We've scrolled the display. */ |
|
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4123 force_p = 1; |
|
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4124 changed_p = 1; |
|
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4125 } |
| 25012 | 4126 |
|
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
4127 /* Update the header line after scrolling because a new header |
| 25012 | 4128 line would otherwise overwrite lines at the top of the window |
| 4129 that can be scrolled. */ | |
| 25546 | 4130 if (header_line_row && header_line_row->enabled_p) |
| 25012 | 4131 { |
| 25546 | 4132 header_line_row->y = 0; |
|
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4133 update_window_line (w, 0, &mouse_face_overwritten_p); |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4134 changed_p = 1; |
| 25012 | 4135 } |
| 4136 | |
| 4137 /* Update the rest of the lines. */ | |
|
34622
877ed6cab304
(update_window): Detect pending input every nth line
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34517
diff
changeset
|
4138 for (n_updated = 0; row < end && (force_p || !input_pending); ++row) |
|
31653
2554afbeb88d
(update_window): Make sure to make desired rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31295
diff
changeset
|
4139 if (row->enabled_p) |
| 25012 | 4140 { |
| 4141 int vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, desired_matrix); | |
| 4142 int i; | |
| 4143 | |
|
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
4144 /* We'll have to play a little bit with when to |
| 25012 | 4145 detect_input_pending. If it's done too often, |
| 4146 scrolling large windows with repeated scroll-up | |
| 4147 commands will too quickly pause redisplay. */ | |
|
34622
877ed6cab304
(update_window): Detect pending input every nth line
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34517
diff
changeset
|
4148 if (!force_p && ++n_updated % preempt_count == 0) |
| 25012 | 4149 detect_input_pending (); |
| 4150 | |
|
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4151 changed_p |= update_window_line (w, vpos, |
|
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4152 &mouse_face_overwritten_p); |
| 25012 | 4153 |
| 4154 /* Mark all rows below the last visible one in the current | |
| 4155 matrix as invalid. This is necessary because of | |
| 4156 variable line heights. Consider the case of three | |
| 4157 successive redisplays, where the first displays 5 | |
| 4158 lines, the second 3 lines, and the third 5 lines again. | |
| 4159 If the second redisplay wouldn't mark rows in the | |
| 4160 current matrix invalid, the third redisplay might be | |
| 4161 tempted to optimize redisplay based on lines displayed | |
| 4162 in the first redisplay. */ | |
| 4163 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= yb) | |
| 4164 for (i = vpos + 1; i < w->current_matrix->nrows - 1; ++i) | |
| 4165 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i)->enabled_p = 0; | |
| 4166 } | |
| 4167 | |
| 4168 /* Was display preempted? */ | |
| 4169 paused_p = row < end; | |
| 4170 | |
|
38489
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4171 set_cursor: |
|
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4172 |
|
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
4173 /* Fix the appearance of overlapping/overlapped rows. */ |
| 25012 | 4174 if (!paused_p && !w->pseudo_window_p) |
| 4175 { | |
|
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4176 if (changed_p && rif->fix_overlapping_area) |
|
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4177 { |
|
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4178 redraw_overlapped_rows (w, yb); |
|
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4179 redraw_overlapping_rows (w, yb); |
|
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4180 } |
|
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4181 |
| 25012 | 4182 /* Make cursor visible at cursor position of W. */ |
| 4183 set_window_cursor_after_update (w); | |
| 4184 | |
|
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4185 #if 0 /* Check that current matrix invariants are satisfied. This is |
|
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4186 for debugging only. See the comment of check_matrix_invariants. */ |
| 25012 | 4187 IF_DEBUG (check_matrix_invariants (w)); |
| 4188 #endif | |
| 4189 } | |
| 4190 | |
| 4191 #if GLYPH_DEBUG | |
| 4192 /* Remember the redisplay method used to display the matrix. */ | |
| 4193 strcpy (w->current_matrix->method, w->desired_matrix->method); | |
| 4194 #endif | |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4195 |
|
38489
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4196 /* End the update of window W. Don't set the cursor if we |
|
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4197 paused updating the display because in this case, |
|
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4198 set_window_cursor_after_update hasn't been called, and |
|
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4199 output_cursor doesn't contain the cursor location. */ |
|
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
4200 rif->update_window_end_hook (w, !paused_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p); |
| 25012 | 4201 } |
| 4202 else | |
| 4203 paused_p = 1; | |
| 4204 | |
|
34893
779bd3fa820e
Use #if GLYPH_DEBUG instead of #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34866
diff
changeset
|
4205 #if GLYPH_DEBUG |
|
34944
4fc804373f2a
(update_window): Don't check_current_matrix_flags.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34929
diff
changeset
|
4206 /* check_current_matrix_flags (w); */ |
|
34866
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
4207 add_window_display_history (w, w->current_matrix->method, paused_p); |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
4208 #endif |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
4209 |
| 25012 | 4210 clear_glyph_matrix (desired_matrix); |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4211 |
| 25012 | 4212 return paused_p; |
| 4213 } | |
| 4214 | |
| 4215 | |
| 4216 /* Update the display of area AREA in window W, row number VPOS. | |
| 4217 AREA can be either LEFT_MARGIN_AREA or RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA. */ | |
| 4218 | |
| 4219 static void | |
| 4220 update_marginal_area (w, area, vpos) | |
| 4221 struct window *w; | |
| 4222 int area, vpos; | |
| 4223 { | |
| 4224 struct glyph_row *desired_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, vpos); | |
| 4225 | |
| 4226 /* Let functions in xterm.c know what area subsequent X positions | |
| 4227 will be relative to. */ | |
| 4228 updated_area = area; | |
| 4229 | |
| 4230 /* Set cursor to start of glyphs, write them, and clear to the end | |
| 4231 of the area. I don't think that something more sophisticated is | |
| 4232 necessary here, since marginal areas will not be the default. */ | |
| 4233 rif->cursor_to (vpos, 0, desired_row->y, 0); | |
| 4234 if (desired_row->used[area]) | |
| 4235 rif->write_glyphs (desired_row->glyphs[area], desired_row->used[area]); | |
| 4236 rif->clear_end_of_line (-1); | |
| 4237 } | |
| 4238 | |
| 4239 | |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4240 /* Update the display of the text area of row VPOS in window W. |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4241 Value is non-zero if display has changed. */ |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4242 |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4243 static int |
| 25012 | 4244 update_text_area (w, vpos) |
| 4245 struct window *w; | |
| 4246 int vpos; | |
| 314 | 4247 { |
| 25012 | 4248 struct glyph_row *current_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos); |
| 4249 struct glyph_row *desired_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, vpos); | |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4250 int changed_p = 0; |
| 25012 | 4251 |
| 4252 /* Let functions in xterm.c know what area subsequent X positions | |
| 4253 will be relative to. */ | |
| 4254 updated_area = TEXT_AREA; | |
| 4255 | |
| 4256 /* If rows are at different X or Y, or rows have different height, | |
| 4257 or the current row is marked invalid, write the entire line. */ | |
| 4258 if (!current_row->enabled_p | |
| 4259 || desired_row->y != current_row->y | |
| 4260 || desired_row->ascent != current_row->ascent | |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4261 || desired_row->phys_ascent != current_row->phys_ascent |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4262 || desired_row->phys_height != current_row->phys_height |
| 25012 | 4263 || desired_row->visible_height != current_row->visible_height |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4264 || current_row->overlapped_p |
|
30307
faf4e303bab7
(update_text_area): Write the whole row if it
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30165
diff
changeset
|
4265 || current_row->mouse_face_p |
| 25012 | 4266 || current_row->x != desired_row->x) |
| 4267 { | |
| 4268 rif->cursor_to (vpos, 0, desired_row->y, desired_row->x); | |
| 4269 | |
| 4270 if (desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]) | |
| 4271 rif->write_glyphs (desired_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], | |
| 4272 desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]); | |
| 4273 | |
| 4274 /* Clear to end of window. */ | |
| 4275 rif->clear_end_of_line (-1); | |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4276 changed_p = 1; |
| 25012 | 4277 } |
| 4278 else | |
| 4279 { | |
| 4280 int stop, i, x; | |
| 4281 struct glyph *current_glyph = current_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; | |
| 4282 struct glyph *desired_glyph = desired_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; | |
|
33596
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4283 int overlapping_glyphs_p = current_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p; |
|
35268
d93bf580d166
(update_text_area): Put code which decrements the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35006
diff
changeset
|
4284 int desired_stop_pos = desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]; |
|
d93bf580d166
(update_text_area): Put code which decrements the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35006
diff
changeset
|
4285 |
| 25012 | 4286 /* If the desired row extends its face to the text area end, |
| 4287 make sure we write at least one glyph, so that the face | |
| 4288 extension actually takes place. */ | |
| 35269 | 4289 if (MATRIX_ROW_EXTENDS_FACE_P (desired_row)) |
|
35268
d93bf580d166
(update_text_area): Put code which decrements the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35006
diff
changeset
|
4290 --desired_stop_pos; |
| 25012 | 4291 |
| 4292 stop = min (current_row->used[TEXT_AREA], desired_stop_pos); | |
| 4293 i = 0; | |
| 4294 x = desired_row->x; | |
|
36097
1dfaaf6d6166
(update_text_area): Undo change of 2001-01-12.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35924
diff
changeset
|
4295 |
|
1dfaaf6d6166
(update_text_area): Undo change of 2001-01-12.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35924
diff
changeset
|
4296 /* Loop over glyphs that current and desired row may have |
|
1dfaaf6d6166
(update_text_area): Undo change of 2001-01-12.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35924
diff
changeset
|
4297 in common. */ |
| 25012 | 4298 while (i < stop) |
| 4299 { | |
|
33603
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4300 int can_skip_p = 1; |
|
33596
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4301 |
| 25012 | 4302 /* Skip over glyphs that both rows have in common. These |
|
33596
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4303 don't have to be written. We can't skip if the last |
|
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4304 current glyph overlaps the glyph to its right. For |
|
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4305 example, consider a current row of `if ' with the `f' in |
|
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4306 Courier bold so that it overlaps the ` ' to its right. |
|
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4307 If the desired row is ` ', we would skip over the space |
|
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4308 after the `if' and there would remain a pixel from the |
|
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4309 `f' on the screen. */ |
|
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4310 if (overlapping_glyphs_p && i > 0) |
| 25012 | 4311 { |
|
33596
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4312 struct glyph *glyph = ¤t_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i - 1]; |
|
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4313 int left, right; |
|
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4314 |
|
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4315 rif->get_glyph_overhangs (glyph, XFRAME (w->frame), |
|
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4316 &left, &right); |
|
33603
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4317 can_skip_p = right == 0; |
| 25012 | 4318 } |
|
33603
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4319 |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4320 if (can_skip_p) |
| 25012 | 4321 { |
|
33603
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4322 while (i < stop |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4323 && GLYPH_EQUAL_P (desired_glyph, current_glyph)) |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4324 { |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4325 x += desired_glyph->pixel_width; |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4326 ++desired_glyph, ++current_glyph, ++i; |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4327 } |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4328 |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4329 /* Consider the case that the current row contains "xxx |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4330 ppp ggg" in italic Courier font, and the desired row |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4331 is "xxx ggg". The character `p' has lbearing, `g' |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4332 has not. The loop above will stop in front of the |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4333 first `p' in the current row. If we would start |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4334 writing glyphs there, we wouldn't erase the lbearing |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4335 of the `p'. The rest of the lbearing problem is then |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4336 taken care of by x_draw_glyphs. */ |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4337 if (overlapping_glyphs_p |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4338 && i > 0 |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4339 && i < current_row->used[TEXT_AREA] |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4340 && (current_row->used[TEXT_AREA] |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4341 != desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA])) |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4342 { |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4343 int left, right; |
|
33596
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4344 |
|
33603
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4345 rif->get_glyph_overhangs (current_glyph, XFRAME (w->frame), |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4346 &left, &right); |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4347 while (left > 0 && i > 0) |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4348 { |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4349 --i, --desired_glyph, --current_glyph; |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4350 x -= desired_glyph->pixel_width; |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4351 left -= desired_glyph->pixel_width; |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4352 } |
| 25012 | 4353 } |
| 4354 } | |
| 4355 | |
| 4356 /* Try to avoid writing the entire rest of the desired row | |
| 4357 by looking for a resync point. This mainly prevents | |
| 4358 mode line flickering in the case the mode line is in | |
| 4359 fixed-pitch font, which it usually will be. */ | |
| 4360 if (i < desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]) | |
| 4361 { | |
| 4362 int start_x = x, start_hpos = i; | |
| 4363 struct glyph *start = desired_glyph; | |
| 4364 int current_x = x; | |
|
33603
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4365 int skip_first_p = !can_skip_p; |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4366 |
| 25012 | 4367 /* Find the next glyph that's equal again. */ |
| 4368 while (i < stop | |
|
33603
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4369 && (skip_first_p |
|
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4370 || !GLYPH_EQUAL_P (desired_glyph, current_glyph)) |
| 25012 | 4371 && x == current_x) |
| 4372 { | |
| 4373 x += desired_glyph->pixel_width; | |
| 4374 current_x += current_glyph->pixel_width; | |
| 4375 ++desired_glyph, ++current_glyph, ++i; | |
|
33603
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4376 skip_first_p = 0; |
| 25012 | 4377 } |
| 4378 | |
| 4379 if (i == start_hpos || x != current_x) | |
| 4380 { | |
| 4381 i = start_hpos; | |
| 4382 x = start_x; | |
| 4383 desired_glyph = start; | |
| 4384 break; | |
| 4385 } | |
|
33596
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4386 |
| 25012 | 4387 rif->cursor_to (vpos, start_hpos, desired_row->y, start_x); |
| 4388 rif->write_glyphs (start, i - start_hpos); | |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4389 changed_p = 1; |
| 25012 | 4390 } |
| 4391 } | |
| 4392 | |
| 4393 /* Write the rest. */ | |
| 4394 if (i < desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]) | |
| 4395 { | |
| 4396 rif->cursor_to (vpos, i, desired_row->y, x); | |
| 4397 rif->write_glyphs (desired_glyph, desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - i); | |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4398 changed_p = 1; |
| 25012 | 4399 } |
| 4400 | |
| 4401 /* Maybe clear to end of line. */ | |
| 4402 if (MATRIX_ROW_EXTENDS_FACE_P (desired_row)) | |
| 4403 { | |
| 4404 /* If new row extends to the end of the text area, nothing | |
| 4405 has to be cleared, if and only if we did a write_glyphs | |
| 4406 above. This is made sure by setting desired_stop_pos | |
| 4407 appropriately above. */ | |
| 4408 xassert (i < desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]); | |
| 4409 } | |
| 4410 else if (MATRIX_ROW_EXTENDS_FACE_P (current_row)) | |
| 4411 { | |
| 4412 /* If old row extends to the end of the text area, clear. */ | |
| 4413 if (i >= desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]) | |
| 4414 rif->cursor_to (vpos, i, desired_row->y, | |
| 4415 desired_row->x + desired_row->pixel_width); | |
| 4416 rif->clear_end_of_line (-1); | |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4417 changed_p = 1; |
| 25012 | 4418 } |
| 4419 else if (desired_row->pixel_width < current_row->pixel_width) | |
| 4420 { | |
| 4421 /* Otherwise clear to the end of the old row. Everything | |
| 4422 after that position should be clear already. */ | |
| 4423 int x; | |
| 4424 | |
| 4425 if (i >= desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]) | |
| 4426 rif->cursor_to (vpos, i, desired_row->y, | |
| 4427 desired_row->x + desired_row->pixel_width); | |
| 4428 | |
| 4429 /* If cursor is displayed at the end of the line, make sure | |
| 4430 it's cleared. Nowadays we don't have a phys_cursor_glyph | |
| 4431 with which to erase the cursor (because this method | |
| 4432 doesn't work with lbearing/rbearing), so we must do it | |
| 4433 this way. */ | |
| 4434 if (vpos == w->phys_cursor.vpos | |
| 4435 && w->phys_cursor.hpos >= desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]) | |
| 4436 { | |
| 4437 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0; | |
| 4438 x = -1; | |
| 4439 } | |
| 4440 else | |
| 4441 x = current_row->x + current_row->pixel_width; | |
| 4442 rif->clear_end_of_line (x); | |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4443 changed_p = 1; |
| 25012 | 4444 } |
| 4445 } | |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4446 |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4447 return changed_p; |
| 25012 | 4448 } |
| 4449 | |
| 4450 | |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4451 /* Update row VPOS in window W. Value is non-zero if display has been |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4452 changed. */ |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4453 |
|
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4454 static int |
|
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4455 update_window_line (w, vpos, mouse_face_overwritten_p) |
| 25012 | 4456 struct window *w; |
|
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4457 int vpos, *mouse_face_overwritten_p; |
| 25012 | 4458 { |
| 4459 struct glyph_row *current_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos); | |
| 4460 struct glyph_row *desired_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, vpos); | |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4461 int changed_p = 0; |
| 25012 | 4462 |
| 4463 /* Set the row being updated. This is important to let xterm.c | |
| 4464 know what line height values are in effect. */ | |
| 4465 updated_row = desired_row; | |
| 4466 | |
|
31690
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4467 /* A row can be completely invisible in case a desired matrix was |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4468 built with a vscroll and then make_cursor_line_fully_visible shifts |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4469 the matrix. Make sure to make such rows current anyway, since |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4470 we need the correct y-position, for example, in the current matrix. */ |
|
31726
59b455472b56
(update_window_line): Make sure to always draw
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31690
diff
changeset
|
4471 if (desired_row->mode_line_p |
|
59b455472b56
(update_window_line): Make sure to always draw
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31690
diff
changeset
|
4472 || desired_row->visible_height > 0) |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4473 { |
|
31690
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4474 xassert (desired_row->enabled_p); |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4475 |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4476 /* Update display of the left margin area, if there is one. */ |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4477 if (!desired_row->full_width_p |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4478 && !NILP (w->left_margin_width)) |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4479 { |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4480 changed_p = 1; |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4481 update_marginal_area (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA, vpos); |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4482 } |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4483 |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4484 /* Update the display of the text area. */ |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4485 if (update_text_area (w, vpos)) |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4486 { |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4487 changed_p = 1; |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4488 if (current_row->mouse_face_p) |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4489 *mouse_face_overwritten_p = 1; |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4490 } |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4491 |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4492 /* Update display of the right margin area, if there is one. */ |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4493 if (!desired_row->full_width_p |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4494 && !NILP (w->right_margin_width)) |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4495 { |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4496 changed_p = 1; |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4497 update_marginal_area (w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA, vpos); |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4498 } |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4499 |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4500 /* Draw truncation marks etc. */ |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4501 if (!current_row->enabled_p |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4502 || desired_row->y != current_row->y |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4503 || desired_row->visible_height != current_row->visible_height |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4504 || desired_row->overlay_arrow_p != current_row->overlay_arrow_p |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4505 || desired_row->truncated_on_left_p != current_row->truncated_on_left_p |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4506 || desired_row->truncated_on_right_p != current_row->truncated_on_right_p |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4507 || desired_row->continued_p != current_row->continued_p |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4508 || desired_row->mode_line_p != current_row->mode_line_p |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4509 || (desired_row->indicate_empty_line_p |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4510 != current_row->indicate_empty_line_p) |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4511 || (MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (desired_row) |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4512 != MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (current_row))) |
|
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4513 rif->after_update_window_line_hook (desired_row); |
|
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4514 } |
| 25012 | 4515 |
| 4516 /* Update current_row from desired_row. */ | |
| 4517 make_current (w->desired_matrix, w->current_matrix, vpos); | |
| 4518 updated_row = NULL; | |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4519 return changed_p; |
| 25012 | 4520 } |
| 4521 | |
| 4522 | |
| 4523 /* Set the cursor after an update of window W. This function may only | |
| 4524 be called from update_window. */ | |
| 4525 | |
| 4526 static void | |
| 4527 set_window_cursor_after_update (w) | |
| 4528 struct window *w; | |
| 4529 { | |
| 4530 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame); | |
| 4531 int cx, cy, vpos, hpos; | |
| 4532 | |
| 4533 /* Not intended for frame matrix updates. */ | |
| 4534 xassert (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)); | |
| 4535 | |
|
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4536 if (cursor_in_echo_area |
|
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4537 && !NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]) |
|
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4538 /* If we are showing a message instead of the mini-buffer, |
|
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4539 show the cursor for the message instead. */ |
|
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4540 && XWINDOW (minibuf_window) == w |
|
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4541 && EQ (minibuf_window, echo_area_window) |
| 25012 | 4542 /* These cases apply only to the frame that contains |
| 4543 the active mini-buffer window. */ | |
| 4544 && FRAME_HAS_MINIBUF_P (f) | |
| 4545 && EQ (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f), echo_area_window)) | |
| 4546 { | |
| 4547 cx = cy = vpos = hpos = 0; | |
| 4548 | |
| 4549 if (cursor_in_echo_area >= 0) | |
| 4550 { | |
| 4551 /* If the mini-buffer is several lines high, find the last | |
| 4552 line that has any text on it. Note: either all lines | |
| 4553 are enabled or none. Otherwise we wouldn't be able to | |
| 4554 determine Y. */ | |
|
25190
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4555 struct glyph_row *row, *last_row; |
|
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4556 struct glyph *glyph; |
|
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4557 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w); |
|
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4558 |
|
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4559 last_row = NULL; |
|
39254
73dd40615520
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Fix code
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39226
diff
changeset
|
4560 row = w->current_matrix->rows; |
|
73dd40615520
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Fix code
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39226
diff
changeset
|
4561 while (row->enabled_p |
|
73dd40615520
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Fix code
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39226
diff
changeset
|
4562 && (last_row == NULL |
|
73dd40615520
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Fix code
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39226
diff
changeset
|
4563 || MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) <= yb)) |
| 25012 | 4564 { |
|
25190
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4565 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA] |
|
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4566 && row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][0].charpos >= 0) |
|
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4567 last_row = row; |
|
39254
73dd40615520
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Fix code
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39226
diff
changeset
|
4568 ++row; |
| 25012 | 4569 } |
|
25190
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4570 |
| 25012 | 4571 if (last_row) |
| 4572 { | |
|
39254
73dd40615520
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Fix code
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39226
diff
changeset
|
4573 struct glyph *start = last_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; |
|
73dd40615520
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Fix code
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39226
diff
changeset
|
4574 struct glyph *last = start + last_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1; |
|
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4575 |
|
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4576 while (last > start && last->charpos < 0) |
|
25190
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4577 --last; |
|
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4578 |
|
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4579 for (glyph = start; glyph < last; ++glyph) |
|
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4580 { |
|
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4581 cx += glyph->pixel_width; |
|
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4582 ++hpos; |
|
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4583 } |
|
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4584 |
| 25012 | 4585 cy = last_row->y; |
|
25190
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4586 vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_row, w->current_matrix); |
| 25012 | 4587 } |
| 4588 } | |
| 4589 } | |
| 4590 else | |
| 4591 { | |
| 4592 cx = w->cursor.x; | |
| 4593 cy = w->cursor.y; | |
| 4594 hpos = w->cursor.hpos; | |
| 4595 vpos = w->cursor.vpos; | |
| 4596 } | |
| 4597 | |
| 4598 /* Window cursor can be out of sync for horizontally split windows. */ | |
| 4599 hpos = max (0, hpos); | |
| 4600 hpos = min (w->current_matrix->matrix_w - 1, hpos); | |
| 4601 vpos = max (0, vpos); | |
| 4602 vpos = min (w->current_matrix->nrows - 1, vpos); | |
| 4603 rif->cursor_to (vpos, hpos, cy, cx); | |
| 4604 } | |
| 4605 | |
| 4606 | |
|
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4607 /* Set WINDOW->must_be_updated_p to ON_P for all windows in the window |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4608 tree rooted at W. */ |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4609 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4610 void |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4611 set_window_update_flags (w, on_p) |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4612 struct window *w; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4613 int on_p; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4614 { |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4615 while (w) |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4616 { |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4617 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4618 set_window_update_flags (XWINDOW (w->hchild), on_p); |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4619 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4620 set_window_update_flags (XWINDOW (w->vchild), on_p); |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4621 else |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4622 w->must_be_updated_p = on_p; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4623 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4624 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4625 } |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4626 } |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4627 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4628 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4629 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4630 /*********************************************************************** |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4631 Window-Based Scrolling |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4632 ***********************************************************************/ |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4633 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4634 /* Structure describing rows in scrolling_window. */ |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4635 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4636 struct row_entry |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4637 { |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4638 /* Number of occurrences of this row in desired and current matrix. */ |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4639 int old_uses, new_uses; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4640 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4641 /* Vpos of row in new matrix. */ |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4642 int new_line_number; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4643 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4644 /* Bucket index of this row_entry in the hash table row_table. */ |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4645 int bucket; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4646 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4647 /* The row described by this entry. */ |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4648 struct glyph_row *row; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4649 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4650 /* Hash collision chain. */ |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4651 struct row_entry *next; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4652 }; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4653 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4654 /* A pool to allocate row_entry structures from, and the size of the |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4655 pool. The pool is reallocated in scrolling_window when we find |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4656 that we need a larger one. */ |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4657 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4658 static struct row_entry *row_entry_pool; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4659 static int row_entry_pool_size; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4660 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4661 /* Index of next free entry in row_entry_pool. */ |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4662 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4663 static int row_entry_idx; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4664 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4665 /* The hash table used during scrolling, and the table's size. This |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4666 table is used to quickly identify equal rows in the desired and |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4667 current matrix. */ |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4668 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4669 static struct row_entry **row_table; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4670 static int row_table_size; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4671 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4672 /* Vectors of pointers to row_entry structures belonging to the |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4673 current and desired matrix, and the size of the vectors. */ |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4674 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4675 static struct row_entry **old_lines, **new_lines; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4676 static int old_lines_size, new_lines_size; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4677 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4678 /* A pool to allocate run structures from, and its size. */ |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4679 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4680 static struct run *run_pool; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4681 static int runs_size; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4682 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4683 /* A vector of runs of lines found during scrolling. */ |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4684 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4685 static struct run **runs; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4686 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4687 /* Add glyph row ROW to the scrolling hash table during the scrolling |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4688 of window W. */ |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4689 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4690 static INLINE struct row_entry * |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4691 add_row_entry (w, row) |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4692 struct window *w; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4693 struct glyph_row *row; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4694 { |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4695 struct row_entry *entry; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4696 int i = row->hash % row_table_size; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4697 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4698 entry = row_table[i]; |
|
30152
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
4699 while (entry && !row_equal_p (w, entry->row, row, 1)) |
|
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4700 entry = entry->next; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4701 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4702 if (entry == NULL) |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4703 { |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4704 entry = row_entry_pool + row_entry_idx++; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4705 entry->row = row; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4706 entry->old_uses = entry->new_uses = 0; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4707 entry->new_line_number = 0; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4708 entry->bucket = i; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4709 entry->next = row_table[i]; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4710 row_table[i] = entry; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4711 } |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4712 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4713 return entry; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4714 } |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4715 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4716 |
| 25012 | 4717 /* Try to reuse part of the current display of W by scrolling lines. |
|
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
4718 HEADER_LINE_P non-zero means W has a header line. |
| 25012 | 4719 |
| 4720 The algorithm is taken from Communications of the ACM, Apr78 "A | |
| 4721 Technique for Isolating Differences Between Files." It should take | |
| 4722 O(N) time. | |
| 4723 | |
| 4724 A short outline of the steps of the algorithm | |
| 4725 | |
| 4726 1. Skip lines equal at the start and end of both matrices. | |
| 4727 | |
| 4728 2. Enter rows in the current and desired matrix into a symbol | |
| 4729 table, counting how often they appear in both matrices. | |
| 4730 | |
| 4731 3. Rows that appear exactly once in both matrices serve as anchors, | |
| 4732 i.e. we assume that such lines are likely to have been moved. | |
| 4733 | |
| 4734 4. Starting from anchor lines, extend regions to be scrolled both | |
| 4735 forward and backward. | |
| 4736 | |
| 4737 Value is | |
| 4738 | |
| 4739 -1 if all rows were found to be equal. | |
| 4740 0 to indicate that we did not scroll the display, or | |
| 4741 1 if we did scroll. */ | |
| 4742 | |
| 4743 static int | |
| 25546 | 4744 scrolling_window (w, header_line_p) |
| 25012 | 4745 struct window *w; |
| 25546 | 4746 int header_line_p; |
| 25012 | 4747 { |
| 4748 struct glyph_matrix *desired_matrix = w->desired_matrix; | |
| 4749 struct glyph_matrix *current_matrix = w->current_matrix; | |
| 4750 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w); | |
|
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4751 int i, j, first_old, first_new, last_old, last_new; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4752 int nruns, nbytes, n, run_idx; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4753 struct row_entry *entry; |
| 25012 | 4754 |
| 4755 /* Skip over rows equal at the start. */ | |
|
31825
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4756 for (i = header_line_p ? 1 : 0; i < current_matrix->nrows - 1; ++i) |
| 25012 | 4757 { |
|
31825
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4758 struct glyph_row *d = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, i); |
|
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4759 struct glyph_row *c = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, i); |
|
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4760 |
|
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4761 if (c->enabled_p |
|
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4762 && d->enabled_p |
|
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4763 && c->y == d->y |
|
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4764 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (c) <= yb |
|
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4765 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (d) <= yb |
|
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4766 && row_equal_p (w, c, d, 1)) |
|
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4767 { |
|
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4768 assign_row (c, d); |
|
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4769 d->enabled_p = 0; |
|
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4770 } |
|
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4771 else |
|
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4772 break; |
| 25012 | 4773 } |
| 4774 | |
| 4775 /* Give up if some rows in the desired matrix are not enabled. */ | |
| 4776 if (!MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, i)->enabled_p) | |
| 4777 return -1; | |
| 4778 | |
| 4779 first_old = first_new = i; | |
| 4780 | |
| 4781 /* Set last_new to the index + 1 of the last enabled row in the | |
| 4782 desired matrix. */ | |
| 4783 i = first_new + 1; | |
| 4784 while (i < desired_matrix->nrows - 1 | |
| 4785 && MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, i)->enabled_p | |
|
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4786 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, i)) <= yb) |
| 25012 | 4787 ++i; |
| 4788 | |
| 4789 if (!MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, i)->enabled_p) | |
| 4790 return 0; | |
| 4791 | |
| 4792 last_new = i; | |
| 4793 | |
| 4794 /* Set last_old to the index + 1 of the last enabled row in the | |
| 4795 current matrix. We don't look at the enabled flag here because | |
| 4796 we plan to reuse part of the display even if other parts are | |
| 4797 disabled. */ | |
| 4798 i = first_old + 1; | |
|
34929
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4799 while (i < current_matrix->nrows - 1) |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4800 { |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4801 int bottom = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, i)); |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4802 if (bottom <= yb) |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4803 ++i; |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4804 if (bottom >= yb) |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4805 break; |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4806 } |
|
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4807 |
| 25012 | 4808 last_old = i; |
| 4809 | |
| 4810 /* Skip over rows equal at the bottom. */ | |
| 4811 i = last_new; | |
| 4812 j = last_old; | |
| 4813 while (i - 1 > first_new | |
| 4814 && j - 1 > first_old | |
| 4815 && MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, i - 1)->enabled_p | |
| 4816 && (MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, i - 1)->y | |
| 4817 == MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, j - 1)->y) | |
| 4818 && row_equal_p (w, | |
| 4819 MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, i - 1), | |
|
30152
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
4820 MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, j - 1), 1)) |
| 25012 | 4821 --i, --j; |
| 4822 last_new = i; | |
| 4823 last_old = j; | |
| 4824 | |
| 4825 /* Nothing to do if all rows are equal. */ | |
| 4826 if (last_new == first_new) | |
| 4827 return 0; | |
| 4828 | |
|
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4829 /* Reallocate vectors, tables etc. if necessary. */ |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4830 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4831 if (current_matrix->nrows > old_lines_size) |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4832 { |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4833 old_lines_size = current_matrix->nrows; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4834 nbytes = old_lines_size * sizeof *old_lines; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4835 old_lines = (struct row_entry **) xrealloc (old_lines, nbytes); |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4836 } |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4837 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4838 if (desired_matrix->nrows > new_lines_size) |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4839 { |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4840 new_lines_size = desired_matrix->nrows; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4841 nbytes = new_lines_size * sizeof *new_lines; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4842 new_lines = (struct row_entry **) xrealloc (new_lines, nbytes); |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4843 } |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4844 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4845 n = desired_matrix->nrows + current_matrix->nrows; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4846 if (3 * n > row_table_size) |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4847 { |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4848 row_table_size = next_almost_prime (3 * n); |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4849 nbytes = row_table_size * sizeof *row_table; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4850 row_table = (struct row_entry **) xrealloc (row_table, nbytes); |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4851 bzero (row_table, nbytes); |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4852 } |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4853 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4854 if (n > row_entry_pool_size) |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4855 { |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4856 row_entry_pool_size = n; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4857 nbytes = row_entry_pool_size * sizeof *row_entry_pool; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4858 row_entry_pool = (struct row_entry *) xrealloc (row_entry_pool, nbytes); |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4859 } |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4860 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4861 if (desired_matrix->nrows > runs_size) |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4862 { |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4863 runs_size = desired_matrix->nrows; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4864 nbytes = runs_size * sizeof *runs; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4865 runs = (struct run **) xrealloc (runs, nbytes); |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4866 nbytes = runs_size * sizeof *run_pool; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4867 run_pool = (struct run *) xrealloc (run_pool, nbytes); |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4868 } |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4869 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4870 nruns = run_idx = 0; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4871 row_entry_idx = 0; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4872 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4873 /* Add rows from the current and desired matrix to the hash table |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4874 row_hash_table to be able to find equal ones quickly. */ |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4875 |
| 25012 | 4876 for (i = first_old; i < last_old; ++i) |
| 4877 { | |
| 4878 if (MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, i)->enabled_p) | |
| 4879 { | |
|
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4880 entry = add_row_entry (w, MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, i)); |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4881 old_lines[i] = entry; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4882 ++entry->old_uses; |
| 25012 | 4883 } |
| 4884 else | |
|
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4885 old_lines[i] = NULL; |
| 25012 | 4886 } |
| 4887 | |
| 4888 for (i = first_new; i < last_new; ++i) | |
| 4889 { | |
| 4890 xassert (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (desired_matrix, i)); | |
|
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4891 entry = add_row_entry (w, MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, i)); |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4892 ++entry->new_uses; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4893 entry->new_line_number = i; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4894 new_lines[i] = entry; |
| 25012 | 4895 } |
| 4896 | |
| 4897 /* Identify moves based on lines that are unique and equal | |
| 4898 in both matrices. */ | |
| 4899 for (i = first_old; i < last_old;) | |
|
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4900 if (old_lines[i] |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4901 && old_lines[i]->old_uses == 1 |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4902 && old_lines[i]->new_uses == 1) |
| 25012 | 4903 { |
| 4904 int j, k; | |
|
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4905 int new_line = old_lines[i]->new_line_number; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4906 struct run *run = run_pool + run_idx++; |
| 25012 | 4907 |
| 4908 /* Record move. */ | |
| 4909 run->current_vpos = i; | |
| 4910 run->current_y = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, i)->y; | |
| 4911 run->desired_vpos = new_line; | |
| 4912 run->desired_y = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, new_line)->y; | |
| 4913 run->nrows = 1; | |
| 4914 run->height = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, i)->height; | |
| 4915 | |
| 4916 /* Extend backward. */ | |
| 4917 j = i - 1; | |
| 4918 k = new_line - 1; | |
| 4919 while (j > first_old | |
| 4920 && k > first_new | |
|
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4921 && old_lines[j] == new_lines[k]) |
| 25012 | 4922 { |
| 4923 int h = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, j)->height; | |
| 4924 --run->current_vpos; | |
| 4925 --run->desired_vpos; | |
| 4926 ++run->nrows; | |
| 4927 run->height += h; | |
| 4928 run->desired_y -= h; | |
| 4929 run->current_y -= h; | |
| 4930 --j, --k; | |
| 4931 } | |
| 4932 | |
| 4933 /* Extend forward. */ | |
| 4934 j = i + 1; | |
| 4935 k = new_line + 1; | |
| 4936 while (j < last_old | |
| 4937 && k < last_new | |
|
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4938 && old_lines[j] == new_lines[k]) |
| 25012 | 4939 { |
| 4940 int h = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, j)->height; | |
| 4941 ++run->nrows; | |
| 4942 run->height += h; | |
| 4943 ++j, ++k; | |
| 4944 } | |
| 4945 | |
| 4946 /* Insert run into list of all runs. Order runs by copied | |
| 4947 pixel lines. Note that we record runs that don't have to | |
| 4948 be copied because they are already in place. This is done | |
| 4949 because we can avoid calling update_window_line in this | |
| 4950 case. */ | |
| 4951 for (j = 0; j < nruns && runs[j]->height > run->height; ++j) | |
| 4952 ; | |
|
34203
e55480843a8e
(scrolling_window): Fix code inserting runs in list of all runs.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33763
diff
changeset
|
4953 for (k = nruns; k > j; --k) |
| 25012 | 4954 runs[k] = runs[k - 1]; |
| 4955 runs[j] = run; | |
| 4956 ++nruns; | |
| 4957 | |
| 4958 i += run->nrows; | |
| 4959 } | |
| 4960 else | |
| 4961 ++i; | |
| 4962 | |
| 4963 /* Do the moves. Do it in a way that we don't overwrite something | |
| 4964 we want to copy later on. This is not solvable in general | |
| 4965 because there is only one display and we don't have a way to | |
| 4966 exchange areas on this display. Example: | |
| 4967 | |
| 4968 +-----------+ +-----------+ | |
| 4969 | A | | B | | |
| 4970 +-----------+ --> +-----------+ | |
| 4971 | B | | A | | |
| 4972 +-----------+ +-----------+ | |
| 4973 | |
| 4974 Instead, prefer bigger moves, and invalidate moves that would | |
| 4975 copy from where we copied to. */ | |
| 4976 | |
| 4977 for (i = 0; i < nruns; ++i) | |
| 4978 if (runs[i]->nrows > 0) | |
| 4979 { | |
| 4980 struct run *r = runs[i]; | |
| 4981 | |
| 4982 /* Copy on the display. */ | |
| 4983 if (r->current_y != r->desired_y) | |
| 4984 { | |
| 4985 rif->scroll_run_hook (w, r); | |
| 4986 | |
| 4987 /* Invalidate runs that copy from where we copied to. */ | |
| 4988 for (j = i + 1; j < nruns; ++j) | |
| 4989 { | |
| 4990 struct run *p = runs[j]; | |
| 4991 | |
| 4992 if ((p->current_y >= r->desired_y | |
| 4993 && p->current_y < r->desired_y + r->height) | |
| 4994 || (p->current_y + p->height >= r->desired_y | |
| 4995 && (p->current_y + p->height | |
| 4996 < r->desired_y + r->height))) | |
| 4997 p->nrows = 0; | |
| 4998 } | |
| 4999 } | |
| 5000 | |
| 5001 /* Assign matrix rows. */ | |
| 5002 for (j = 0; j < r->nrows; ++j) | |
| 5003 { | |
| 5004 struct glyph_row *from, *to; | |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
5005 int to_overlapped_p; |
|
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
5006 |
| 25012 | 5007 to = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, r->desired_vpos + j); |
|
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
5008 from = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, r->desired_vpos + j); |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
5009 to_overlapped_p = to->overlapped_p; |
| 25012 | 5010 assign_row (to, from); |
| 5011 to->enabled_p = 1, from->enabled_p = 0; | |
|
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
5012 to->overlapped_p = to_overlapped_p; |
| 25012 | 5013 } |
| 5014 } | |
| 5015 | |
|
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
5016 /* Clear the hash table, for the next time. */ |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
5017 for (i = 0; i < row_entry_idx; ++i) |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
5018 row_table[row_entry_pool[i].bucket] = NULL; |
|
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
5019 |
| 25012 | 5020 /* Value is non-zero to indicate that we scrolled the display. */ |
| 5021 return 1; | |
| 5022 } | |
| 5023 | |
| 5024 | |
| 5025 | |
| 5026 /************************************************************************ | |
| 5027 Frame-Based Updates | |
| 5028 ************************************************************************/ | |
| 5029 | |
| 5030 /* Update the desired frame matrix of frame F. | |
| 5031 | |
| 5032 FORCE_P non-zero means that the update should not be stopped by | |
| 5033 pending input. INHIBIT_HAIRY_ID_P non-zero means that scrolling | |
| 5034 should not be tried. | |
| 5035 | |
| 5036 Value is non-zero if update was stopped due to pending input. */ | |
| 5037 | |
| 5038 static int | |
| 5039 update_frame_1 (f, force_p, inhibit_id_p) | |
| 5040 struct frame *f; | |
| 5041 int force_p; | |
| 5042 int inhibit_id_p; | |
| 5043 { | |
| 5044 /* Frame matrices to work on. */ | |
| 5045 struct glyph_matrix *current_matrix = f->current_matrix; | |
| 5046 struct glyph_matrix *desired_matrix = f->desired_matrix; | |
| 5047 int i; | |
| 314 | 5048 int pause; |
| 5049 int preempt_count = baud_rate / 2400 + 1; | |
| 21514 | 5050 extern int input_pending; |
| 25012 | 5051 |
| 5052 xassert (current_matrix && desired_matrix); | |
| 314 | 5053 |
|
10122
3de6776ae141
(update_frame): Call calculate_costs if baud_rate changed.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
9963
diff
changeset
|
5054 if (baud_rate != FRAME_COST_BAUD_RATE (f)) |
|
3de6776ae141
(update_frame): Call calculate_costs if baud_rate changed.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
9963
diff
changeset
|
5055 calculate_costs (f); |
|
3de6776ae141
(update_frame): Call calculate_costs if baud_rate changed.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
9963
diff
changeset
|
5056 |
|
3357
d9523a958b3c
(update_frame): Make preempt_count positive.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
3317
diff
changeset
|
5057 if (preempt_count <= 0) |
|
d9523a958b3c
(update_frame): Make preempt_count positive.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
3317
diff
changeset
|
5058 preempt_count = 1; |
|
d9523a958b3c
(update_frame): Make preempt_count positive.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
3317
diff
changeset
|
5059 |
|
30720
64f3338f72d8
(Qredisplay_dont_pause): New variable.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30713
diff
changeset
|
5060 if (redisplay_dont_pause) |
|
64f3338f72d8
(Qredisplay_dont_pause): New variable.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30713
diff
changeset
|
5061 force_p = 1; |
|
64f3338f72d8
(Qredisplay_dont_pause): New variable.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30713
diff
changeset
|
5062 else if (!force_p && detect_input_pending ()) |
| 314 | 5063 { |
| 5064 pause = 1; | |
| 5065 goto do_pause; | |
| 5066 } | |
| 5067 | |
| 25012 | 5068 /* If we cannot insert/delete lines, it's no use trying it. */ |
| 314 | 5069 if (!line_ins_del_ok) |
| 25012 | 5070 inhibit_id_p = 1; |
|
7188
7da4ad9a2a8f
(update_frame): Move those assignments even farther down.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7179
diff
changeset
|
5071 |
| 493 | 5072 /* See if any of the desired lines are enabled; don't compute for |
| 25012 | 5073 i/d line if just want cursor motion. */ |
| 5074 for (i = 0; i < desired_matrix->nrows; i++) | |
| 5075 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (desired_matrix, i)) | |
| 314 | 5076 break; |
| 5077 | |
| 5078 /* Try doing i/d line, if not yet inhibited. */ | |
| 25012 | 5079 if (!inhibit_id_p && i < desired_matrix->nrows) |
| 5080 force_p |= scrolling (f); | |
| 314 | 5081 |
| 5082 /* Update the individual lines as needed. Do bottom line first. */ | |
| 25012 | 5083 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (desired_matrix, desired_matrix->nrows - 1)) |
| 5084 update_frame_line (f, desired_matrix->nrows - 1); | |
| 5085 | |
| 5086 /* Now update the rest of the lines. */ | |
| 5087 for (i = 0; i < desired_matrix->nrows - 1 && (force_p || !input_pending); i++) | |
| 314 | 5088 { |
| 25012 | 5089 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (desired_matrix, i)) |
| 314 | 5090 { |
|
960
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5091 if (FRAME_TERMCAP_P (f)) |
| 314 | 5092 { |
| 5093 /* Flush out every so many lines. | |
| 5094 Also flush out if likely to have more than 1k buffered | |
| 5095 otherwise. I'm told that some telnet connections get | |
| 5096 really screwed by more than 1k output at once. */ | |
| 5097 int outq = PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT (stdout); | |
| 5098 if (outq > 900 | |
| 5099 || (outq > 20 && ((i - 1) % preempt_count == 0))) | |
| 5100 { | |
| 5101 fflush (stdout); | |
| 5102 if (preempt_count == 1) | |
| 5103 { | |
| 554 | 5104 #ifdef EMACS_OUTQSIZE |
| 5105 if (EMACS_OUTQSIZE (0, &outq) < 0) | |
| 314 | 5106 /* Probably not a tty. Ignore the error and reset |
|
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
5107 the outq count. */ |
| 314 | 5108 outq = PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT (stdout); |
| 5109 #endif | |
| 5110 outq *= 10; | |
|
7530
57c2345a9002
(update_frame): Fix test of outq and baud_rate some more.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7529
diff
changeset
|
5111 if (baud_rate <= outq && baud_rate > 0) |
|
3357
d9523a958b3c
(update_frame): Make preempt_count positive.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
3317
diff
changeset
|
5112 sleep (outq / baud_rate); |
| 314 | 5113 } |
| 5114 } | |
| 5115 } | |
| 5116 | |
|
16822
483e137d5384
(update_frame): Call detect_input_pending
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16589
diff
changeset
|
5117 if ((i - 1) % preempt_count == 0) |
|
483e137d5384
(update_frame): Call detect_input_pending
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16589
diff
changeset
|
5118 detect_input_pending (); |
|
483e137d5384
(update_frame): Call detect_input_pending
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16589
diff
changeset
|
5119 |
| 25012 | 5120 update_frame_line (f, i); |
| 314 | 5121 } |
| 5122 } | |
| 25012 | 5123 |
| 764 | 5124 pause = (i < FRAME_HEIGHT (f) - 1) ? i : 0; |
| 314 | 5125 |
| 5126 /* Now just clean up termcap drivers and set cursor, etc. */ | |
| 5127 if (!pause) | |
| 5128 { | |
|
12409
6e374b28ecc3
(update_frame): Pretend cursor is in echo area
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12193
diff
changeset
|
5129 if ((cursor_in_echo_area |
| 25012 | 5130 /* If we are showing a message instead of the mini-buffer, |
|
12627
c7bc7a24b1ff
(update_frame): Check that the echo area is in the frame being displayed.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12532
diff
changeset
|
5131 show the cursor for the message instead of for the |
| 25012 | 5132 (now hidden) mini-buffer contents. */ |
|
12627
c7bc7a24b1ff
(update_frame): Check that the echo area is in the frame being displayed.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12532
diff
changeset
|
5133 || (EQ (minibuf_window, selected_window) |
|
c7bc7a24b1ff
(update_frame): Check that the echo area is in the frame being displayed.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12532
diff
changeset
|
5134 && EQ (minibuf_window, echo_area_window) |
|
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5135 && !NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))) |
|
12627
c7bc7a24b1ff
(update_frame): Check that the echo area is in the frame being displayed.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12532
diff
changeset
|
5136 /* These cases apply only to the frame that contains |
| 25012 | 5137 the active mini-buffer window. */ |
|
12627
c7bc7a24b1ff
(update_frame): Check that the echo area is in the frame being displayed.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12532
diff
changeset
|
5138 && FRAME_HAS_MINIBUF_P (f) |
|
14459
c1d25453a95f
(update_frame): Compare FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW(f)
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
14286
diff
changeset
|
5139 && EQ (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f), echo_area_window)) |
| 708 | 5140 { |
|
1042
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5141 int top = XINT (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f))->top); |
|
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5142 int row, col; |
|
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5143 |
|
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5144 if (cursor_in_echo_area < 0) |
|
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5145 { |
| 25012 | 5146 /* Negative value of cursor_in_echo_area means put |
| 5147 cursor at beginning of line. */ | |
|
1042
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5148 row = top; |
|
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5149 col = 0; |
|
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5150 } |
| 708 | 5151 else |
|
1042
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5152 { |
| 25012 | 5153 /* Positive value of cursor_in_echo_area means put |
| 5154 cursor at the end of the prompt. If the mini-buffer | |
| 5155 is several lines high, find the last line that has | |
| 5156 any text on it. */ | |
|
1042
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5157 row = FRAME_HEIGHT (f); |
|
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5158 do |
|
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5159 { |
| 25012 | 5160 --row; |
| 5161 col = 0; | |
| 5162 | |
| 5163 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (current_matrix, row)) | |
| 5164 { | |
| 5165 /* Frame rows are filled up with spaces that | |
| 5166 must be ignored here. */ | |
| 5167 struct glyph_row *r = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, | |
| 5168 row); | |
| 5169 struct glyph *start = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; | |
| 5170 struct glyph *last = start + r->used[TEXT_AREA]; | |
| 5171 | |
| 5172 while (last > start | |
| 5173 && (last - 1)->charpos < 0) | |
| 5174 --last; | |
| 5175 | |
| 5176 col = last - start; | |
| 5177 } | |
|
1042
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5178 } |
|
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5179 while (row > top && col == 0); |
|
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5180 |
|
21757
629f6df4a329
(update_frame): Move echo area cursor into range.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21514
diff
changeset
|
5181 /* Make sure COL is not out of range. */ |
|
21763
b685f9451792
(change_frame_size_1): Use FRAME_CURSOR_X_LIMIT.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21757
diff
changeset
|
5182 if (col >= FRAME_CURSOR_X_LIMIT (f)) |
|
1042
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5183 { |
|
21757
629f6df4a329
(update_frame): Move echo area cursor into range.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21514
diff
changeset
|
5184 /* If we have another row, advance cursor into it. */ |
|
1042
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5185 if (row < FRAME_HEIGHT (f) - 1) |
|
21757
629f6df4a329
(update_frame): Move echo area cursor into range.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21514
diff
changeset
|
5186 { |
|
629f6df4a329
(update_frame): Move echo area cursor into range.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21514
diff
changeset
|
5187 col = FRAME_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f); |
|
629f6df4a329
(update_frame): Move echo area cursor into range.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21514
diff
changeset
|
5188 row++; |
|
629f6df4a329
(update_frame): Move echo area cursor into range.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21514
diff
changeset
|
5189 } |
|
629f6df4a329
(update_frame): Move echo area cursor into range.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21514
diff
changeset
|
5190 /* Otherwise move it back in range. */ |
|
629f6df4a329
(update_frame): Move echo area cursor into range.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21514
diff
changeset
|
5191 else |
|
21763
b685f9451792
(change_frame_size_1): Use FRAME_CURSOR_X_LIMIT.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21757
diff
changeset
|
5192 col = FRAME_CURSOR_X_LIMIT (f) - 1; |
|
1042
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5193 } |
|
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5194 } |
|
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5195 |
|
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5196 cursor_to (row, col); |
| 708 | 5197 } |
| 314 | 5198 else |
| 25012 | 5199 { |
| 5200 /* We have only one cursor on terminal frames. Use it to | |
| 5201 display the cursor of the selected window. */ | |
| 5202 struct window *w = XWINDOW (FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f)); | |
|
29687
5d67ef29764b
(update_frame_1): Handle case that cursor vpos is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29437
diff
changeset
|
5203 if (w->cursor.vpos >= 0 |
|
5d67ef29764b
(update_frame_1): Handle case that cursor vpos is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29437
diff
changeset
|
5204 /* The cursor vpos may be temporarily out of bounds |
|
5d67ef29764b
(update_frame_1): Handle case that cursor vpos is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29437
diff
changeset
|
5205 in the following situation: There is one window, |
|
5d67ef29764b
(update_frame_1): Handle case that cursor vpos is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29437
diff
changeset
|
5206 with the cursor in the lower half of it. The window |
|
5d67ef29764b
(update_frame_1): Handle case that cursor vpos is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29437
diff
changeset
|
5207 is split, and a message causes a redisplay before |
|
5d67ef29764b
(update_frame_1): Handle case that cursor vpos is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29437
diff
changeset
|
5208 a new cursor position has been computed. */ |
|
5d67ef29764b
(update_frame_1): Handle case that cursor vpos is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29437
diff
changeset
|
5209 && w->cursor.vpos < XFASTINT (w->height)) |
| 25012 | 5210 { |
| 5211 int x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_HPOS (w, w->cursor.hpos); | |
| 5212 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_VPOS (w, w->cursor.vpos); | |
| 5213 | |
| 5214 if (INTEGERP (w->left_margin_width)) | |
| 5215 x += XFASTINT (w->left_margin_width); | |
| 5216 | |
| 5217 /* x = max (min (x, FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (f) - 1), 0); */ | |
| 5218 cursor_to (y, x); | |
| 5219 } | |
| 5220 } | |
| 314 | 5221 } |
| 5222 | |
| 5223 do_pause: | |
| 5224 | |
| 25012 | 5225 clear_desired_matrices (f); |
| 314 | 5226 return pause; |
| 5227 } | |
| 5228 | |
| 25012 | 5229 |
| 5230 /* Do line insertions/deletions on frame F for frame-based redisplay. */ | |
| 314 | 5231 |
| 21514 | 5232 int |
| 764 | 5233 scrolling (frame) |
| 25012 | 5234 struct frame *frame; |
| 314 | 5235 { |
| 5236 int unchanged_at_top, unchanged_at_bottom; | |
| 5237 int window_size; | |
| 5238 int changed_lines; | |
| 764 | 5239 int *old_hash = (int *) alloca (FRAME_HEIGHT (frame) * sizeof (int)); |
| 5240 int *new_hash = (int *) alloca (FRAME_HEIGHT (frame) * sizeof (int)); | |
| 5241 int *draw_cost = (int *) alloca (FRAME_HEIGHT (frame) * sizeof (int)); | |
|
10259
48e4dfc6bb43
(scrolling): Fewer restrictions if scroll_region_ok is
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10122
diff
changeset
|
5242 int *old_draw_cost = (int *) alloca (FRAME_HEIGHT (frame) * sizeof (int)); |
| 314 | 5243 register int i; |
| 764 | 5244 int free_at_end_vpos = FRAME_HEIGHT (frame); |
| 25012 | 5245 struct glyph_matrix *current_matrix = frame->current_matrix; |
| 5246 struct glyph_matrix *desired_matrix = frame->desired_matrix; | |
| 5247 | |
| 5248 if (!current_matrix) | |
| 5249 abort (); | |
| 5250 | |
| 5251 /* Compute hash codes of all the lines. Also calculate number of | |
| 5252 changed lines, number of unchanged lines at the beginning, and | |
| 5253 number of unchanged lines at the end. */ | |
| 314 | 5254 changed_lines = 0; |
| 5255 unchanged_at_top = 0; | |
| 764 | 5256 unchanged_at_bottom = FRAME_HEIGHT (frame); |
| 5257 for (i = 0; i < FRAME_HEIGHT (frame); i++) | |
| 314 | 5258 { |
| 5259 /* Give up on this scrolling if some old lines are not enabled. */ | |
| 25012 | 5260 if (!MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (current_matrix, i)) |
| 314 | 5261 return 0; |
| 25012 | 5262 old_hash[i] = line_hash_code (MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, i)); |
| 5263 if (! MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (desired_matrix, i)) | |
|
18015
934a44a3b34f
(scrolling): If a line is not enabled,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17961
diff
changeset
|
5264 { |
|
934a44a3b34f
(scrolling): If a line is not enabled,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17961
diff
changeset
|
5265 /* This line cannot be redrawn, so don't let scrolling mess it. */ |
|
934a44a3b34f
(scrolling): If a line is not enabled,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17961
diff
changeset
|
5266 new_hash[i] = old_hash[i]; |
|
934a44a3b34f
(scrolling): If a line is not enabled,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17961
diff
changeset
|
5267 #define INFINITY 1000000 /* Taken from scroll.c */ |
|
934a44a3b34f
(scrolling): If a line is not enabled,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17961
diff
changeset
|
5268 draw_cost[i] = INFINITY; |
|
934a44a3b34f
(scrolling): If a line is not enabled,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17961
diff
changeset
|
5269 } |
| 314 | 5270 else |
|
18015
934a44a3b34f
(scrolling): If a line is not enabled,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17961
diff
changeset
|
5271 { |
| 25012 | 5272 new_hash[i] = line_hash_code (MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, i)); |
| 5273 draw_cost[i] = line_draw_cost (desired_matrix, i); | |
|
18015
934a44a3b34f
(scrolling): If a line is not enabled,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17961
diff
changeset
|
5274 } |
| 314 | 5275 |
| 5276 if (old_hash[i] != new_hash[i]) | |
| 5277 { | |
| 5278 changed_lines++; | |
| 764 | 5279 unchanged_at_bottom = FRAME_HEIGHT (frame) - i - 1; |
| 314 | 5280 } |
| 5281 else if (i == unchanged_at_top) | |
| 5282 unchanged_at_top++; | |
| 25012 | 5283 old_draw_cost[i] = line_draw_cost (current_matrix, i); |
| 314 | 5284 } |
| 5285 | |
| 5286 /* If changed lines are few, don't allow preemption, don't scroll. */ | |
| 25012 | 5287 if ((!scroll_region_ok && changed_lines < baud_rate / 2400) |
| 764 | 5288 || unchanged_at_bottom == FRAME_HEIGHT (frame)) |
| 314 | 5289 return 1; |
| 5290 | |
| 764 | 5291 window_size = (FRAME_HEIGHT (frame) - unchanged_at_top |
| 314 | 5292 - unchanged_at_bottom); |
| 5293 | |
| 5294 if (scroll_region_ok) | |
| 5295 free_at_end_vpos -= unchanged_at_bottom; | |
| 764 | 5296 else if (memory_below_frame) |
| 314 | 5297 free_at_end_vpos = -1; |
| 5298 | |
| 5299 /* If large window, fast terminal and few lines in common between | |
| 25012 | 5300 current frame and desired frame, don't bother with i/d calc. */ |
|
10259
48e4dfc6bb43
(scrolling): Fewer restrictions if scroll_region_ok is
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10122
diff
changeset
|
5301 if (!scroll_region_ok && window_size >= 18 && baud_rate > 2400 |
| 314 | 5302 && (window_size >= |
| 5303 10 * scrolling_max_lines_saved (unchanged_at_top, | |
| 764 | 5304 FRAME_HEIGHT (frame) - unchanged_at_bottom, |
| 314 | 5305 old_hash, new_hash, draw_cost))) |
| 5306 return 0; | |
| 5307 | |
| 25012 | 5308 if (window_size < 2) |
| 5309 return 0; | |
| 5310 | |
| 764 | 5311 scrolling_1 (frame, window_size, unchanged_at_top, unchanged_at_bottom, |
| 314 | 5312 draw_cost + unchanged_at_top - 1, |
|
10259
48e4dfc6bb43
(scrolling): Fewer restrictions if scroll_region_ok is
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10122
diff
changeset
|
5313 old_draw_cost + unchanged_at_top - 1, |
| 314 | 5314 old_hash + unchanged_at_top - 1, |
| 5315 new_hash + unchanged_at_top - 1, | |
| 5316 free_at_end_vpos - unchanged_at_top); | |
| 5317 | |
| 5318 return 0; | |
| 5319 } | |
| 25012 | 5320 |
| 5321 | |
| 5322 /* Count the number of blanks at the start of the vector of glyphs R | |
| 5323 which is LEN glyphs long. */ | |
| 5324 | |
| 5325 static int | |
| 5326 count_blanks (r, len) | |
| 5327 struct glyph *r; | |
| 5328 int len; | |
| 314 | 5329 { |
| 25012 | 5330 int i; |
|
33101
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5331 |
| 25012 | 5332 for (i = 0; i < len; ++i) |
| 5333 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_SPACE_P (r[i])) | |
| 5334 break; | |
| 5335 | |
| 5336 return i; | |
| 314 | 5337 } |
| 25012 | 5338 |
| 5339 | |
| 5340 /* Count the number of glyphs in common at the start of the glyph | |
| 5341 vectors STR1 and STR2. END1 is the end of STR1 and END2 is the end | |
| 5342 of STR2. Value is the number of equal glyphs equal at the start. */ | |
| 314 | 5343 |
| 5344 static int | |
| 25012 | 5345 count_match (str1, end1, str2, end2) |
| 5346 struct glyph *str1, *end1, *str2, *end2; | |
| 314 | 5347 { |
| 25012 | 5348 struct glyph *p1 = str1; |
| 5349 struct glyph *p2 = str2; | |
| 5350 | |
| 5351 while (p1 < end1 | |
| 5352 && p2 < end2 | |
|
26998
02e902f732d1
(line_hash_code) (direct_output_for_insert): Adjusted
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
26902
diff
changeset
|
5353 && GLYPH_CHAR_AND_FACE_EQUAL_P (p1, p2)) |
| 25012 | 5354 ++p1, ++p2; |
| 5355 | |
| 5356 return p1 - str1; | |
| 314 | 5357 } |
| 5358 | |
| 25012 | 5359 |
| 314 | 5360 /* Char insertion/deletion cost vector, from term.c */ |
| 25012 | 5361 |
| 314 | 5362 extern int *char_ins_del_vector; |
|
16267
05ca2cb9fe0f
(make_frame_glyphs, update_line, update_frame)
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16256
diff
changeset
|
5363 #define char_ins_del_cost(f) (&char_ins_del_vector[FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH((f))]) |
| 314 | 5364 |
| 25012 | 5365 |
| 5366 /* Perform a frame-based update on line VPOS in frame FRAME. */ | |
| 5367 | |
| 314 | 5368 static void |
|
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5369 update_frame_line (f, vpos) |
|
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5370 struct frame *f; |
| 314 | 5371 int vpos; |
| 5372 { | |
| 25012 | 5373 struct glyph *obody, *nbody, *op1, *op2, *np1, *nend; |
| 314 | 5374 int tem; |
| 5375 int osp, nsp, begmatch, endmatch, olen, nlen; | |
|
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5376 struct glyph_matrix *current_matrix = f->current_matrix; |
|
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5377 struct glyph_matrix *desired_matrix = f->desired_matrix; |
| 25012 | 5378 struct glyph_row *current_row = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, vpos); |
| 5379 struct glyph_row *desired_row = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, vpos); | |
| 5380 int must_write_whole_line_p; | |
|
33101
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5381 int write_spaces_p = must_write_spaces; |
|
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5382 int colored_spaces_p = (FACE_FROM_ID (f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID)->background |
|
33101
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5383 != FACE_TTY_DEFAULT_BG_COLOR); |
|
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5384 |
|
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5385 if (colored_spaces_p) |
|
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5386 write_spaces_p = 1; |
| 25012 | 5387 |
|
25725
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5388 /* Current row not enabled means it has unknown contents. We must |
|
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5389 write the whole desired line in that case. */ |
| 25012 | 5390 must_write_whole_line_p = !current_row->enabled_p; |
| 5391 if (must_write_whole_line_p) | |
| 314 | 5392 { |
| 25012 | 5393 obody = 0; |
| 314 | 5394 olen = 0; |
| 5395 } | |
| 5396 else | |
| 5397 { | |
| 25012 | 5398 obody = MATRIX_ROW_GLYPH_START (current_matrix, vpos); |
| 5399 olen = current_row->used[TEXT_AREA]; | |
| 5400 | |
|
40075
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
5401 /* Ignore trailing spaces, if we can. */ |
|
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
5402 if (!write_spaces_p) |
|
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
5403 while (olen > 0 && CHAR_GLYPH_SPACE_P (obody[olen-1])) |
|
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
5404 olen--; |
| 314 | 5405 } |
| 5406 | |
| 25012 | 5407 current_row->enabled_p = 1; |
| 5408 current_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]; | |
| 5409 | |
| 5410 /* If desired line is empty, just clear the line. */ | |
| 5411 if (!desired_row->enabled_p) | |
| 314 | 5412 { |
| 5413 nlen = 0; | |
| 5414 goto just_erase; | |
| 5415 } | |
| 5416 | |
| 25012 | 5417 nbody = desired_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; |
| 5418 nlen = desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]; | |
| 5419 nend = nbody + nlen; | |
| 5420 | |
| 5421 /* If display line has unknown contents, write the whole line. */ | |
| 5422 if (must_write_whole_line_p) | |
| 5423 { | |
|
25725
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5424 /* Ignore spaces at the end, if we can. */ |
|
33101
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5425 if (!write_spaces_p) |
|
25313
6b4475fbef86
(update_frame_line): If writing whole line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25304
diff
changeset
|
5426 while (nlen > 0 && CHAR_GLYPH_SPACE_P (nbody[nlen - 1])) |
|
6b4475fbef86
(update_frame_line): If writing whole line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25304
diff
changeset
|
5427 --nlen; |
|
6b4475fbef86
(update_frame_line): If writing whole line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25304
diff
changeset
|
5428 |
|
25725
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5429 /* Write the contents of the desired line. */ |
|
25313
6b4475fbef86
(update_frame_line): If writing whole line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25304
diff
changeset
|
5430 if (nlen) |
|
25725
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5431 { |
|
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5432 cursor_to (vpos, 0); |
|
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5433 write_glyphs (nbody, nlen); |
|
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5434 } |
|
25313
6b4475fbef86
(update_frame_line): If writing whole line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25304
diff
changeset
|
5435 |
|
25725
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5436 /* Don't call clear_end_of_line if we already wrote the whole |
|
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5437 line. The cursor will not be at the right margin in that |
|
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5438 case but in the line below. */ |
|
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5439 if (nlen < FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (f)) |
|
25725
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5440 { |
|
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5441 cursor_to (vpos, nlen); |
|
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5442 clear_end_of_line (FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (f)); |
|
25725
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5443 } |
|
28682
f05d48759416
(update_frame_line): When writing a whole line, make
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28507
diff
changeset
|
5444 else |
|
f05d48759416
(update_frame_line): When writing a whole line, make
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28507
diff
changeset
|
5445 /* Make sure we are in the right row, otherwise cursor movement |
|
f05d48759416
(update_frame_line): When writing a whole line, make
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28507
diff
changeset
|
5446 with cmgoto might use `ch' in the wrong row. */ |
|
f05d48759416
(update_frame_line): When writing a whole line, make
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28507
diff
changeset
|
5447 cursor_to (vpos, 0); |
|
f05d48759416
(update_frame_line): When writing a whole line, make
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28507
diff
changeset
|
5448 |
| 25012 | 5449 make_current (desired_matrix, current_matrix, vpos); |
| 5450 return; | |
| 5451 } | |
| 314 | 5452 |
| 5453 /* Pretend trailing spaces are not there at all, | |
| 5454 unless for one reason or another we must write all spaces. */ | |
|
40075
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
5455 if (!write_spaces_p) |
|
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
5456 while (nlen > 0 && CHAR_GLYPH_SPACE_P (nbody[nlen - 1])) |
|
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
5457 nlen--; |
| 314 | 5458 |
| 5459 /* If there's no i/d char, quickly do the best we can without it. */ | |
| 5460 if (!char_ins_del_ok) | |
| 5461 { | |
| 25012 | 5462 int i, j; |
| 5463 | |
| 5464 /* Find the first glyph in desired row that doesn't agree with | |
| 5465 a glyph in the current row, and write the rest from there on. */ | |
| 314 | 5466 for (i = 0; i < nlen; i++) |
| 5467 { | |
| 25012 | 5468 if (i >= olen || !GLYPH_EQUAL_P (nbody + i, obody + i)) |
| 314 | 5469 { |
| 25012 | 5470 /* Find the end of the run of different glyphs. */ |
| 5471 j = i + 1; | |
| 5472 while (j < nlen | |
| 5473 && (j >= olen | |
| 5474 || !GLYPH_EQUAL_P (nbody + j, obody + j) | |
| 5475 || CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (nbody[j]))) | |
| 5476 ++j; | |
| 5477 | |
| 5478 /* Output this run of non-matching chars. */ | |
| 314 | 5479 cursor_to (vpos, i); |
| 25012 | 5480 write_glyphs (nbody + i, j - i); |
| 5481 i = j - 1; | |
| 314 | 5482 |
| 5483 /* Now find the next non-match. */ | |
| 5484 } | |
| 5485 } | |
| 5486 | |
| 5487 /* Clear the rest of the line, or the non-clear part of it. */ | |
| 5488 if (olen > nlen) | |
| 5489 { | |
| 5490 cursor_to (vpos, nlen); | |
| 5491 clear_end_of_line (olen); | |
| 5492 } | |
| 5493 | |
| 25012 | 5494 /* Make current row = desired row. */ |
| 5495 make_current (desired_matrix, current_matrix, vpos); | |
| 314 | 5496 return; |
| 5497 } | |
| 5498 | |
| 25012 | 5499 /* Here when CHAR_INS_DEL_OK != 0, i.e. we can insert or delete |
| 5500 characters in a row. */ | |
| 5501 | |
| 314 | 5502 if (!olen) |
| 5503 { | |
| 25012 | 5504 /* If current line is blank, skip over initial spaces, if |
| 5505 possible, and write the rest. */ | |
|
40075
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
5506 if (write_spaces_p) |
| 25012 | 5507 nsp = 0; |
| 5508 else | |
| 5509 nsp = count_blanks (nbody, nlen); | |
| 5510 | |
| 314 | 5511 if (nlen > nsp) |
| 5512 { | |
| 5513 cursor_to (vpos, nsp); | |
| 5514 write_glyphs (nbody + nsp, nlen - nsp); | |
| 5515 } | |
| 5516 | |
| 764 | 5517 /* Exchange contents between current_frame and new_frame. */ |
| 25012 | 5518 make_current (desired_matrix, current_matrix, vpos); |
| 314 | 5519 return; |
| 5520 } | |
| 5521 | |
| 5522 /* Compute number of leading blanks in old and new contents. */ | |
| 25012 | 5523 osp = count_blanks (obody, olen); |
|
40075
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
5524 nsp = (colored_spaces_p ? 0 : count_blanks (nbody, nlen)); |
| 25012 | 5525 |
| 5526 /* Compute number of matching chars starting with first non-blank. */ | |
| 5527 begmatch = count_match (obody + osp, obody + olen, | |
| 5528 nbody + nsp, nbody + nlen); | |
| 314 | 5529 |
| 5530 /* Spaces in new match implicit space past the end of old. */ | |
| 5531 /* A bug causing this to be a no-op was fixed in 18.29. */ | |
|
33101
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5532 if (!write_spaces_p && osp + begmatch == olen) |
| 314 | 5533 { |
| 5534 np1 = nbody + nsp; | |
| 25012 | 5535 while (np1 + begmatch < nend && CHAR_GLYPH_SPACE_P (np1[begmatch])) |
| 5536 ++begmatch; | |
| 314 | 5537 } |
| 5538 | |
| 5539 /* Avoid doing insert/delete char | |
| 5540 just cause number of leading spaces differs | |
| 25012 | 5541 when the following text does not match. */ |
| 314 | 5542 if (begmatch == 0 && osp != nsp) |
| 5543 osp = nsp = min (osp, nsp); | |
| 5544 | |
| 5545 /* Find matching characters at end of line */ | |
| 5546 op1 = obody + olen; | |
| 5547 np1 = nbody + nlen; | |
| 5548 op2 = op1 + begmatch - min (olen - osp, nlen - nsp); | |
| 25012 | 5549 while (op1 > op2 |
| 5550 && GLYPH_EQUAL_P (op1 - 1, np1 - 1)) | |
| 314 | 5551 { |
| 5552 op1--; | |
| 5553 np1--; | |
| 5554 } | |
| 5555 endmatch = obody + olen - op1; | |
| 5556 | |
| 5557 /* tem gets the distance to insert or delete. | |
| 5558 endmatch is how many characters we save by doing so. | |
| 5559 Is it worth it? */ | |
| 5560 | |
| 5561 tem = (nlen - nsp) - (olen - osp); | |
| 5562 if (endmatch && tem | |
|
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5563 && (!char_ins_del_ok || endmatch <= char_ins_del_cost (f)[tem])) |
| 314 | 5564 endmatch = 0; |
| 5565 | |
| 5566 /* nsp - osp is the distance to insert or delete. | |
| 5567 If that is nonzero, begmatch is known to be nonzero also. | |
| 5568 begmatch + endmatch is how much we save by doing the ins/del. | |
| 5569 Is it worth it? */ | |
| 5570 | |
| 5571 if (nsp != osp | |
| 5572 && (!char_ins_del_ok | |
|
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5573 || begmatch + endmatch <= char_ins_del_cost (f)[nsp - osp])) |
| 314 | 5574 { |
| 5575 begmatch = 0; | |
| 5576 endmatch = 0; | |
| 5577 osp = nsp = min (osp, nsp); | |
| 5578 } | |
| 5579 | |
| 5580 /* Now go through the line, inserting, writing and | |
| 5581 deleting as appropriate. */ | |
| 5582 | |
| 5583 if (osp > nsp) | |
| 5584 { | |
| 5585 cursor_to (vpos, nsp); | |
| 5586 delete_glyphs (osp - nsp); | |
| 5587 } | |
| 5588 else if (nsp > osp) | |
| 5589 { | |
| 5590 /* If going to delete chars later in line | |
| 5591 and insert earlier in the line, | |
| 5592 must delete first to avoid losing data in the insert */ | |
| 5593 if (endmatch && nlen < olen + nsp - osp) | |
| 5594 { | |
| 5595 cursor_to (vpos, nlen - endmatch + osp - nsp); | |
| 5596 delete_glyphs (olen + nsp - osp - nlen); | |
| 5597 olen = nlen - (nsp - osp); | |
| 5598 } | |
| 5599 cursor_to (vpos, osp); | |
| 25012 | 5600 insert_glyphs (0, nsp - osp); |
| 314 | 5601 } |
| 5602 olen += nsp - osp; | |
| 5603 | |
| 5604 tem = nsp + begmatch + endmatch; | |
| 5605 if (nlen != tem || olen != tem) | |
| 5606 { | |
| 5607 if (!endmatch || nlen == olen) | |
| 5608 { | |
|
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5609 /* If new text being written reaches right margin, there is |
|
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5610 no need to do clear-to-eol at the end of this function |
|
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5611 (and it would not be safe, since cursor is not going to |
|
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5612 be "at the margin" after the text is done). */ |
|
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5613 if (nlen == FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (f)) |
| 314 | 5614 olen = 0; |
|
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5615 |
|
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5616 /* Function write_glyphs is prepared to do nothing |
|
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5617 if passed a length <= 0. Check it here to avoid |
|
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5618 unnecessary cursor movement. */ |
|
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5619 if (nlen - tem > 0) |
|
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5620 { |
|
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5621 cursor_to (vpos, nsp + begmatch); |
|
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5622 write_glyphs (nbody + nsp + begmatch, nlen - tem); |
|
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5623 } |
| 314 | 5624 } |
| 5625 else if (nlen > olen) | |
| 5626 { | |
|
17015
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5627 /* Here, we used to have the following simple code: |
|
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5628 ---------------------------------------- |
|
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5629 write_glyphs (nbody + nsp + begmatch, olen - tem); |
|
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5630 insert_glyphs (nbody + nsp + begmatch + olen - tem, nlen - olen); |
|
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5631 ---------------------------------------- |
|
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5632 but it doesn't work if nbody[nsp + begmatch + olen - tem] |
|
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5633 is a padding glyph. */ |
|
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5634 int out = olen - tem; /* Columns to be overwritten originally. */ |
|
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5635 int del; |
|
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5636 |
|
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5637 cursor_to (vpos, nsp + begmatch); |
|
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5638 |
|
17015
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5639 /* Calculate columns we can actually overwrite. */ |
|
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5640 while (CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (nbody[nsp + begmatch + out])) |
|
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5641 out--; |
|
17015
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5642 write_glyphs (nbody + nsp + begmatch, out); |
|
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5643 |
| 25012 | 5644 /* If we left columns to be overwritten, we must delete them. */ |
|
17015
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5645 del = olen - tem - out; |
|
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5646 if (del > 0) |
|
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5647 delete_glyphs (del); |
|
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5648 |
|
17015
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5649 /* At last, we insert columns not yet written out. */ |
|
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5650 insert_glyphs (nbody + nsp + begmatch + out, nlen - olen + del); |
| 314 | 5651 olen = nlen; |
| 5652 } | |
| 5653 else if (olen > nlen) | |
| 5654 { | |
|
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5655 cursor_to (vpos, nsp + begmatch); |
| 314 | 5656 write_glyphs (nbody + nsp + begmatch, nlen - tem); |
| 5657 delete_glyphs (olen - nlen); | |
| 5658 olen = nlen; | |
| 5659 } | |
| 5660 } | |
| 5661 | |
| 5662 just_erase: | |
| 5663 /* If any unerased characters remain after the new line, erase them. */ | |
| 5664 if (olen > nlen) | |
| 5665 { | |
| 5666 cursor_to (vpos, nlen); | |
| 5667 clear_end_of_line (olen); | |
| 5668 } | |
| 5669 | |
| 764 | 5670 /* Exchange contents between current_frame and new_frame. */ |
| 25012 | 5671 make_current (desired_matrix, current_matrix, vpos); |
| 314 | 5672 } |
| 25012 | 5673 |
| 5674 | |
| 314 | 5675 |
| 25012 | 5676 /*********************************************************************** |
| 5677 X/Y Position -> Buffer Position | |
| 5678 ***********************************************************************/ | |
| 5679 | |
|
36697
7526acd3385c
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Add parameters OBJECT and
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36590
diff
changeset
|
5680 /* Determine what's under window-relative pixel position (*X, *Y). |
|
7526acd3385c
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Add parameters OBJECT and
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36590
diff
changeset
|
5681 Return in *OBJECT the object (string or buffer) that's there. |
|
7526acd3385c
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Add parameters OBJECT and
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36590
diff
changeset
|
5682 Return in *POS the position in that object. Adjust *X and *Y |
|
7526acd3385c
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Add parameters OBJECT and
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36590
diff
changeset
|
5683 to character boundaries. */ |
|
7526acd3385c
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Add parameters OBJECT and
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36590
diff
changeset
|
5684 |
|
7526acd3385c
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Add parameters OBJECT and
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36590
diff
changeset
|
5685 void |
|
7526acd3385c
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Add parameters OBJECT and
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36590
diff
changeset
|
5686 buffer_posn_from_coords (w, x, y, object, pos) |
| 25012 | 5687 struct window *w; |
| 5688 int *x, *y; | |
|
36697
7526acd3385c
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Add parameters OBJECT and
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36590
diff
changeset
|
5689 Lisp_Object *object; |
|
7526acd3385c
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Add parameters OBJECT and
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36590
diff
changeset
|
5690 struct display_pos *pos; |
|
7810
15c0bf73737e
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): New function.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
7808
diff
changeset
|
5691 { |
| 25012 | 5692 struct it it; |
| 5693 struct buffer *old_current_buffer = current_buffer; | |
| 5694 struct text_pos startp; | |
| 5695 int left_area_width; | |
| 5696 | |
| 5697 current_buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer); | |
| 5698 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start); | |
| 5699 CHARPOS (startp) = min (ZV, max (BEGV, CHARPOS (startp))); | |
| 5700 BYTEPOS (startp) = min (ZV_BYTE, max (BEGV_BYTE, BYTEPOS (startp))); | |
| 5701 start_display (&it, w, startp); | |
| 5702 | |
| 5703 left_area_width = WINDOW_DISPLAY_LEFT_AREA_PIXEL_WIDTH (w); | |
| 5704 move_it_to (&it, -1, *x + it.first_visible_x - left_area_width, *y, -1, | |
| 5705 MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_Y); | |
| 5706 | |
| 5707 *x = it.current_x - it.first_visible_x + left_area_width; | |
| 5708 *y = it.current_y; | |
| 5709 current_buffer = old_current_buffer; | |
|
36697
7526acd3385c
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Add parameters OBJECT and
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36590
diff
changeset
|
5710 |
|
7526acd3385c
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Add parameters OBJECT and
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36590
diff
changeset
|
5711 *object = STRINGP (it.string) ? it.string : w->buffer; |
|
7526acd3385c
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Add parameters OBJECT and
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36590
diff
changeset
|
5712 *pos = it.current; |
| 25012 | 5713 } |
| 5714 | |
| 5715 | |
| 5716 /* Value is the string under window-relative coordinates X/Y in the | |
|
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
5717 mode or header line of window W, or nil if none. MODE_LINE_P non-zero |
| 25012 | 5718 means look at the mode line. *CHARPOS is set to the position in |
| 5719 the string returned. */ | |
| 5720 | |
| 5721 Lisp_Object | |
| 5722 mode_line_string (w, x, y, mode_line_p, charpos) | |
| 5723 struct window *w; | |
|
30713
fee809f81f97
(mode_line_string): Declare parameter MODE_LINE_P.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30323
diff
changeset
|
5724 int x, y, mode_line_p; |
| 25012 | 5725 int *charpos; |
| 5726 { | |
| 5727 struct glyph_row *row; | |
| 5728 struct glyph *glyph, *end; | |
| 5729 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame); | |
| 5730 int x0; | |
| 5731 Lisp_Object string = Qnil; | |
| 5732 | |
| 5733 if (mode_line_p) | |
| 5734 row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix); | |
| 5735 else | |
| 25546 | 5736 row = MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix); |
| 25012 | 5737 |
| 5738 if (row->mode_line_p && row->enabled_p) | |
|
11919
31cb053405f2
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Record frame names
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
5739 { |
| 41120 | 5740 /* The mode lines are displayed over scroll bars and fringes, |
| 5741 and X is window-relative. Correct X by the scroll bar | |
| 5742 and fringe width. */ | |
| 25012 | 5743 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_LEFT (f)) |
| 5744 x += FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * CANON_X_UNIT (f); | |
| 41120 | 5745 x += FRAME_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f); |
| 25012 | 5746 |
| 5747 /* Find the glyph under X. If we find one with a string object, | |
| 5748 it's the one we were looking for. */ | |
| 5749 glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; | |
| 5750 end = glyph + row->used[TEXT_AREA]; | |
| 5751 for (x0 = 0; glyph < end; x0 += glyph->pixel_width, ++glyph) | |
| 5752 if (x >= x0 && x < x0 + glyph->pixel_width) | |
| 5753 { | |
| 5754 string = glyph->object; | |
| 5755 *charpos = glyph->charpos; | |
| 5756 break; | |
| 5757 } | |
|
7810
15c0bf73737e
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): New function.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
7808
diff
changeset
|
5758 } |
| 25012 | 5759 |
| 5760 return string; | |
|
7810
15c0bf73737e
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): New function.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
7808
diff
changeset
|
5761 } |
| 25012 | 5762 |
| 5763 | |
| 5764 /*********************************************************************** | |
| 5765 Changing Frame Sizes | |
| 5766 ***********************************************************************/ | |
| 314 | 5767 |
| 5768 #ifdef SIGWINCH | |
| 25012 | 5769 |
| 493 | 5770 SIGTYPE |
|
10745
a553a08f5785
(window_change_signal): Add ignored argument.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10259
diff
changeset
|
5771 window_change_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */ |
| 25012 | 5772 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */ |
| 314 | 5773 { |
| 5774 int width, height; | |
|
31093
6da961dff718
Include keyboard.h before frame.h.
Andrew Innes <andrewi@gnu.org>
parents:
30720
diff
changeset
|
5775 #ifndef USE_CRT_DLL |
| 314 | 5776 extern int errno; |
|
31093
6da961dff718
Include keyboard.h before frame.h.
Andrew Innes <andrewi@gnu.org>
parents:
30720
diff
changeset
|
5777 #endif |
| 314 | 5778 int old_errno = errno; |
| 5779 | |
| 764 | 5780 get_frame_size (&width, &height); |
| 314 | 5781 |
| 764 | 5782 /* The frame size change obviously applies to a termcap-controlled |
| 5783 frame. Find such a frame in the list, and assume it's the only | |
| 314 | 5784 one (since the redisplay code always writes to stdout, not a |
| 764 | 5785 FILE * specified in the frame structure). Record the new size, |
| 314 | 5786 but don't reallocate the data structures now. Let that be done |
| 5787 later outside of the signal handler. */ | |
| 5788 | |
| 5789 { | |
|
2252
9793d8654e23
* frame.h (FOR_EACH_FRAME): Change the definition so that
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2198
diff
changeset
|
5790 Lisp_Object tail, frame; |
| 314 | 5791 |
|
2252
9793d8654e23
* frame.h (FOR_EACH_FRAME): Change the definition so that
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2198
diff
changeset
|
5792 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame) |
| 314 | 5793 { |
|
2252
9793d8654e23
* frame.h (FOR_EACH_FRAME): Change the definition so that
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2198
diff
changeset
|
5794 if (FRAME_TERMCAP_P (XFRAME (frame))) |
| 314 | 5795 { |
|
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5796 change_frame_size (XFRAME (frame), height, width, 0, 1, 0); |
| 314 | 5797 break; |
| 5798 } | |
| 5799 } | |
| 5800 } | |
| 5801 | |
| 5802 signal (SIGWINCH, window_change_signal); | |
| 5803 errno = old_errno; | |
| 5804 } | |
| 5805 #endif /* SIGWINCH */ | |
| 5806 | |
| 5807 | |
|
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5808 /* Do any change in frame size that was requested by a signal. SAFE |
|
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5809 non-zero means this function is called from a place where it is |
|
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5810 safe to change frame sizes while a redisplay is in progress. */ |
| 314 | 5811 |
| 21514 | 5812 void |
|
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5813 do_pending_window_change (safe) |
|
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5814 int safe; |
| 314 | 5815 { |
| 5816 /* If window_change_signal should have run before, run it now. */ | |
|
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5817 if (redisplaying_p && !safe) |
|
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5818 return; |
|
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5819 |
| 314 | 5820 while (delayed_size_change) |
| 5821 { | |
|
2252
9793d8654e23
* frame.h (FOR_EACH_FRAME): Change the definition so that
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2198
diff
changeset
|
5822 Lisp_Object tail, frame; |
| 314 | 5823 |
| 5824 delayed_size_change = 0; | |
| 5825 | |
|
2252
9793d8654e23
* frame.h (FOR_EACH_FRAME): Change the definition so that
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2198
diff
changeset
|
5826 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame) |
| 314 | 5827 { |
| 25012 | 5828 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame); |
|
2252
9793d8654e23
* frame.h (FOR_EACH_FRAME): Change the definition so that
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2198
diff
changeset
|
5829 |
| 764 | 5830 int height = FRAME_NEW_HEIGHT (f); |
| 5831 int width = FRAME_NEW_WIDTH (f); | |
| 314 | 5832 |
|
3449
ad455da9b789
(do_pending_window_change): No need to clear
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
3357
diff
changeset
|
5833 if (height != 0 || width != 0) |
|
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5834 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 0, safe); |
| 314 | 5835 } |
| 5836 } | |
| 5837 } | |
| 5838 | |
| 5839 | |
| 764 | 5840 /* Change the frame height and/or width. Values may be given as zero to |
|
960
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5841 indicate no change is to take place. |
| 314 | 5842 |
|
960
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5843 If DELAY is non-zero, then assume we're being called from a signal |
|
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5844 handler, and queue the change for later - perhaps the next |
|
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5845 redisplay. Since this tries to resize windows, we can't call it |
|
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5846 from a signal handler. |
|
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5847 |
|
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5848 SAFE non-zero means this function is called from a place where it's |
|
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5849 safe to change frame sizes while a redisplay is in progress. */ |
|
960
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5850 |
| 21514 | 5851 void |
|
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5852 change_frame_size (f, newheight, newwidth, pretend, delay, safe) |
| 25012 | 5853 register struct frame *f; |
|
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5854 int newheight, newwidth, pretend, delay, safe; |
|
10770
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5855 { |
|
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5856 Lisp_Object tail, frame; |
|
16881
245ba9f2781a
(change_frame_size_1): Reject new sizes if they cause overflow.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16822
diff
changeset
|
5857 |
|
15395
b584c2db055f
(change_frame_size, remake_frame_glyphs): Use FRAME_WINDOW_P.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
15394
diff
changeset
|
5858 if (! FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)) |
|
10770
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5859 { |
|
15394
8d01f71c4797
(Fredraw_frame, remake_frame_glyphs)
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
15282
diff
changeset
|
5860 /* When using termcap, or on MS-DOS, all frames use |
|
8d01f71c4797
(Fredraw_frame, remake_frame_glyphs)
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
15282
diff
changeset
|
5861 the same screen, so a change in size affects all frames. */ |
|
10770
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5862 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame) |
|
15395
b584c2db055f
(change_frame_size, remake_frame_glyphs): Use FRAME_WINDOW_P.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
15394
diff
changeset
|
5863 if (! FRAME_WINDOW_P (XFRAME (frame))) |
|
10770
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5864 change_frame_size_1 (XFRAME (frame), newheight, newwidth, |
|
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5865 pretend, delay, safe); |
|
10770
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5866 } |
|
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5867 else |
|
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5868 change_frame_size_1 (f, newheight, newwidth, pretend, delay, safe); |
|
10770
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5869 } |
|
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5870 |
|
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5871 static void |
|
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5872 change_frame_size_1 (f, newheight, newwidth, pretend, delay, safe) |
| 25012 | 5873 register struct frame *f; |
|
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5874 int newheight, newwidth, pretend, delay, safe; |
| 314 | 5875 { |
|
16256
1ce0cb94fa68
(preserve_other_columns, preserve_my_columns): Use new
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16195
diff
changeset
|
5876 int new_frame_window_width; |
|
19627
c6343f7a9c6c
(change_frame_size_1): Save current buffer
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19063
diff
changeset
|
5877 int count = specpdl_ptr - specpdl; |
|
16881
245ba9f2781a
(change_frame_size_1): Reject new sizes if they cause overflow.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16822
diff
changeset
|
5878 |
| 314 | 5879 /* If we can't deal with the change now, queue it for later. */ |
|
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5880 if (delay || (redisplaying_p && !safe)) |
| 314 | 5881 { |
| 25012 | 5882 FRAME_NEW_HEIGHT (f) = newheight; |
| 5883 FRAME_NEW_WIDTH (f) = newwidth; | |
| 314 | 5884 delayed_size_change = 1; |
| 5885 return; | |
| 5886 } | |
| 5887 | |
| 764 | 5888 /* This size-change overrides any pending one for this frame. */ |
| 25012 | 5889 FRAME_NEW_HEIGHT (f) = 0; |
| 5890 FRAME_NEW_WIDTH (f) = 0; | |
|
960
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5891 |
|
3449
ad455da9b789
(do_pending_window_change): No need to clear
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
3357
diff
changeset
|
5892 /* If an argument is zero, set it to the current value. */ |
|
15896
3a3c30116313
(change_frame_size_1): Clean up conditional.
Erik Naggum <erik@naggum.no>
parents:
15687
diff
changeset
|
5893 if (newheight == 0) |
| 25012 | 5894 newheight = FRAME_HEIGHT (f); |
|
15896
3a3c30116313
(change_frame_size_1): Clean up conditional.
Erik Naggum <erik@naggum.no>
parents:
15687
diff
changeset
|
5895 if (newwidth == 0) |
| 25012 | 5896 newwidth = FRAME_WIDTH (f); |
| 5897 | |
| 5898 /* Compute width of windows in F. | |
| 5899 This is the width of the frame without vertical scroll bars. */ | |
| 5900 new_frame_window_width = FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH_ARG (f, newwidth); | |
|
16881
245ba9f2781a
(change_frame_size_1): Reject new sizes if they cause overflow.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16822
diff
changeset
|
5901 |
|
960
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5902 /* Round up to the smallest acceptable size. */ |
| 25012 | 5903 check_frame_size (f, &newheight, &newwidth); |
|
960
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5904 |
|
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5905 /* If we're not changing the frame size, quit now. */ |
| 25012 | 5906 if (newheight == FRAME_HEIGHT (f) |
| 5907 && new_frame_window_width == FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (f)) | |
| 314 | 5908 return; |
| 5909 | |
| 15078 | 5910 BLOCK_INPUT; |
| 5911 | |
|
14286
5d42664b4e74
(change_frame_size_1) [MSDOS]: Support frame size
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14186
diff
changeset
|
5912 #ifdef MSDOS |
|
5d42664b4e74
(change_frame_size_1) [MSDOS]: Support frame size
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14186
diff
changeset
|
5913 /* We only can set screen dimensions to certain values supported |
|
5d42664b4e74
(change_frame_size_1) [MSDOS]: Support frame size
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14186
diff
changeset
|
5914 by our video hardware. Try to find the smallest size greater |
|
5d42664b4e74
(change_frame_size_1) [MSDOS]: Support frame size
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14186
diff
changeset
|
5915 or equal to the requested dimensions. */ |
|
5d42664b4e74
(change_frame_size_1) [MSDOS]: Support frame size
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14186
diff
changeset
|
5916 dos_set_window_size (&newheight, &newwidth); |
|
5d42664b4e74
(change_frame_size_1) [MSDOS]: Support frame size
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14186
diff
changeset
|
5917 #endif |
|
5d42664b4e74
(change_frame_size_1) [MSDOS]: Support frame size
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14186
diff
changeset
|
5918 |
| 25012 | 5919 if (newheight != FRAME_HEIGHT (f)) |
| 314 | 5920 { |
| 25012 | 5921 if (FRAME_HAS_MINIBUF_P (f) && !FRAME_MINIBUF_ONLY_P (f)) |
| 314 | 5922 { |
| 25012 | 5923 /* Frame has both root and mini-buffer. */ |
| 5924 XSETFASTINT (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f))->top, | |
| 5925 FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f)); | |
| 5926 set_window_height (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f), | |
| 5927 (newheight | |
| 5928 - 1 | |
| 5929 - FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f)), | |
| 5930 0); | |
| 5931 XSETFASTINT (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f))->top, | |
|
9303
3115ae493c30
(direct_output_for_insert, direct_output_forward_char, change_frame_size,
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
9264
diff
changeset
|
5932 newheight - 1); |
| 25012 | 5933 set_window_height (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f), 1, 0); |
| 314 | 5934 } |
| 5935 else | |
| 764 | 5936 /* Frame has just one top-level window. */ |
| 25012 | 5937 set_window_height (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f), |
| 5938 newheight - FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f), 0); | |
| 5939 | |
| 5940 if (FRAME_TERMCAP_P (f) && !pretend) | |
|
960
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5941 FrameRows = newheight; |
| 314 | 5942 } |
| 5943 | |
| 25012 | 5944 if (new_frame_window_width != FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (f)) |
| 314 | 5945 { |
| 25012 | 5946 set_window_width (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f), new_frame_window_width, 0); |
| 5947 if (FRAME_HAS_MINIBUF_P (f)) | |
| 5948 set_window_width (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f), new_frame_window_width, 0); | |
| 5949 | |
| 5950 if (FRAME_TERMCAP_P (f) && !pretend) | |
| 764 | 5951 FrameCols = newwidth; |
| 25012 | 5952 |
|
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
5953 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)) |
|
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
5954 XSETFASTINT (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)->width, newwidth); |
| 314 | 5955 } |
| 5956 | |
| 25012 | 5957 FRAME_HEIGHT (f) = newheight; |
| 5958 SET_FRAME_WIDTH (f, newwidth); | |
| 5959 | |
| 5960 { | |
| 5961 struct window *w = XWINDOW (FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f)); | |
| 5962 int text_area_x, text_area_y, text_area_width, text_area_height; | |
| 5963 | |
| 5964 window_box (w, TEXT_AREA, &text_area_x, &text_area_y, &text_area_width, | |
| 5965 &text_area_height); | |
| 5966 if (w->cursor.x >= text_area_x + text_area_width) | |
| 5967 w->cursor.hpos = w->cursor.x = 0; | |
| 5968 if (w->cursor.y >= text_area_y + text_area_height) | |
| 5969 w->cursor.vpos = w->cursor.y = 0; | |
| 5970 } | |
| 5971 | |
| 5972 adjust_glyphs (f); | |
|
40512
d256f6fc9c05
(change_frame_size_1): Set frame's resized_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40334
diff
changeset
|
5973 calculate_costs (f); |
| 25012 | 5974 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f); |
|
40512
d256f6fc9c05
(change_frame_size_1): Set frame's resized_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40334
diff
changeset
|
5975 f->resized_p = 1; |
| 15065 | 5976 |
| 5977 UNBLOCK_INPUT; | |
|
17282
5023bea28298
(change_frame_size_1): Call Fset_window_buffer,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17015
diff
changeset
|
5978 |
|
19627
c6343f7a9c6c
(change_frame_size_1): Save current buffer
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19063
diff
changeset
|
5979 record_unwind_protect (Fset_buffer, Fcurrent_buffer ()); |
|
c6343f7a9c6c
(change_frame_size_1): Save current buffer
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19063
diff
changeset
|
5980 |
|
17282
5023bea28298
(change_frame_size_1): Call Fset_window_buffer,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17015
diff
changeset
|
5981 /* This isn't quite a no-op: it runs window-configuration-change-hook. */ |
| 25012 | 5982 Fset_window_buffer (FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f), |
| 5983 XWINDOW (FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f))->buffer); | |
|
19627
c6343f7a9c6c
(change_frame_size_1): Save current buffer
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19063
diff
changeset
|
5984 |
|
c6343f7a9c6c
(change_frame_size_1): Save current buffer
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19063
diff
changeset
|
5985 unbind_to (count, Qnil); |
| 314 | 5986 } |
| 25012 | 5987 |
| 5988 | |
| 314 | 5989 |
| 25012 | 5990 /*********************************************************************** |
| 5991 Terminal Related Lisp Functions | |
| 5992 ***********************************************************************/ | |
| 5993 | |
| 5994 DEFUN ("open-termscript", Fopen_termscript, Sopen_termscript, | |
|
39914
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
5995 1, 1, "FOpen termscript file: ", |
|
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
5996 doc: /* Start writing all terminal output to FILE as well as the terminal. |
|
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
5997 FILE = nil means just close any termscript file currently open. */) |
|
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
5998 (file) |
| 25012 | 5999 Lisp_Object file; |
| 6000 { | |
| 6001 if (termscript != 0) fclose (termscript); | |
| 6002 termscript = 0; | |
| 6003 | |
| 6004 if (! NILP (file)) | |
| 6005 { | |
| 6006 file = Fexpand_file_name (file, Qnil); | |
| 6007 termscript = fopen (XSTRING (file)->data, "w"); | |
| 6008 if (termscript == 0) | |
| 6009 report_file_error ("Opening termscript", Fcons (file, Qnil)); | |
| 6010 } | |
| 6011 return Qnil; | |
| 6012 } | |
| 6013 | |
| 6014 | |
| 314 | 6015 DEFUN ("send-string-to-terminal", Fsend_string_to_terminal, |
|
39914
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6016 Ssend_string_to_terminal, 1, 1, 0, |
|
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6017 doc: /* Send STRING to the terminal without alteration. |
|
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6018 Control characters in STRING will have terminal-dependent effects. */) |
|
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6019 (string) |
|
14068
a3c83dde295e
(Fsend_string_to_terminal, Fsit_for): Harmonize arguments with
Erik Naggum <erik@naggum.no>
parents:
13526
diff
changeset
|
6020 Lisp_Object string; |
| 314 | 6021 { |
|
20618
d5acac3af6e3
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Use size_byte.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19627
diff
changeset
|
6022 /* ??? Perhaps we should do something special for multibyte strings here. */ |
|
40656
cdfd4d09b79a
Update usage of CHECK_ macros (remove unused second argument).
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
40512
diff
changeset
|
6023 CHECK_STRING (string); |
|
21244
50929073a0ba
Use STRING_BYTES and SET_STRING_BYTES.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
20708
diff
changeset
|
6024 fwrite (XSTRING (string)->data, 1, STRING_BYTES (XSTRING (string)), stdout); |
| 314 | 6025 fflush (stdout); |
| 6026 if (termscript) | |
| 6027 { | |
|
21244
50929073a0ba
Use STRING_BYTES and SET_STRING_BYTES.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
20708
diff
changeset
|
6028 fwrite (XSTRING (string)->data, 1, STRING_BYTES (XSTRING (string)), |
|
50929073a0ba
Use STRING_BYTES and SET_STRING_BYTES.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
20708
diff
changeset
|
6029 termscript); |
| 314 | 6030 fflush (termscript); |
| 6031 } | |
| 6032 return Qnil; | |
| 6033 } | |
| 6034 | |
| 25012 | 6035 |
| 314 | 6036 DEFUN ("ding", Fding, Sding, 0, 1, 0, |
|
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6037 doc: /* Beep, or flash the screen. |
|
39914
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6038 Also, unless an argument is given, |
|
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6039 terminate any keyboard macro currently executing. */) |
|
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6040 (arg) |
| 314 | 6041 Lisp_Object arg; |
| 6042 { | |
| 493 | 6043 if (!NILP (arg)) |
| 314 | 6044 { |
|
649
61deba7b73b6
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
587
diff
changeset
|
6045 if (noninteractive) |
|
61deba7b73b6
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
587
diff
changeset
|
6046 putchar (07); |
|
61deba7b73b6
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
587
diff
changeset
|
6047 else |
|
61deba7b73b6
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
587
diff
changeset
|
6048 ring_bell (); |
| 314 | 6049 fflush (stdout); |
| 6050 } | |
| 6051 else | |
| 6052 bitch_at_user (); | |
| 6053 | |
| 6054 return Qnil; | |
| 6055 } | |
| 6056 | |
| 21514 | 6057 void |
| 314 | 6058 bitch_at_user () |
| 6059 { | |
| 6060 if (noninteractive) | |
| 6061 putchar (07); | |
| 25012 | 6062 else if (!INTERACTIVE) /* Stop executing a keyboard macro. */ |
| 314 | 6063 error ("Keyboard macro terminated by a command ringing the bell"); |
| 6064 else | |
| 6065 ring_bell (); | |
| 6066 fflush (stdout); | |
| 6067 } | |
| 6068 | |
| 25012 | 6069 |
| 6070 | |
| 6071 /*********************************************************************** | |
| 6072 Sleeping, Waiting | |
| 6073 ***********************************************************************/ | |
| 6074 | |
| 314 | 6075 DEFUN ("sleep-for", Fsleep_for, Ssleep_for, 1, 2, 0, |
|
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6076 doc: /* Pause, without updating display, for SECONDS seconds. |
|
39914
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6077 SECONDS may be a floating-point value, meaning that you can wait for a |
|
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6078 fraction of a second. Optional second arg MILLISECONDS specifies an |
|
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6079 additional wait period, in milliseconds; this may be useful if your |
|
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6080 Emacs was built without floating point support. |
|
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6081 \(Not all operating systems support waiting for a fraction of a second.) */) |
|
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6082 (seconds, milliseconds) |
|
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6083 Lisp_Object seconds, milliseconds; |
| 314 | 6084 { |
|
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6085 int sec, usec; |
|
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6086 |
|
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6087 if (NILP (milliseconds)) |
|
9264
9338a124ea84
(redraw_frame, Fsleep_for, sit_for, Fsit_for): Use new accessor macros instead
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
8903
diff
changeset
|
6088 XSETINT (milliseconds, 0); |
|
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6089 else |
|
40656
cdfd4d09b79a
Update usage of CHECK_ macros (remove unused second argument).
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
40512
diff
changeset
|
6090 CHECK_NUMBER (milliseconds); |
| 2648 | 6091 usec = XINT (milliseconds) * 1000; |
| 6092 | |
| 6093 { | |
| 6094 double duration = extract_float (seconds); | |
| 6095 sec = (int) duration; | |
| 6096 usec += (duration - sec) * 1000000; | |
| 6097 } | |
| 314 | 6098 |
|
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6099 #ifndef EMACS_HAS_USECS |
|
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6100 if (sec == 0 && usec != 0) |
|
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6101 error ("millisecond `sleep-for' not supported on %s", SYSTEM_TYPE); |
|
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6102 #endif |
|
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6103 |
|
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6104 /* Assure that 0 <= usec < 1000000. */ |
|
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6105 if (usec < 0) |
|
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6106 { |
|
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
6107 /* We can't rely on the rounding being correct if usec is negative. */ |
|
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6108 if (-1000000 < usec) |
|
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6109 sec--, usec += 1000000; |
|
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6110 else |
|
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6111 sec -= -usec / 1000000, usec = 1000000 - (-usec % 1000000); |
|
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6112 } |
|
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6113 else |
|
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6114 sec += usec / 1000000, usec %= 1000000; |
|
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6115 |
|
14646
68fe10d1abd0
(Fsleep_for): Accept sub-second intervals.
Erik Naggum <erik@naggum.no>
parents:
14459
diff
changeset
|
6116 if (sec < 0 || (sec == 0 && usec == 0)) |
| 314 | 6117 return Qnil; |
| 6118 | |
| 650 | 6119 { |
| 6120 Lisp_Object zero; | |
| 6121 | |
|
9303
3115ae493c30
(direct_output_for_insert, direct_output_forward_char, change_frame_size,
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
9264
diff
changeset
|
6122 XSETFASTINT (zero, 0); |
| 650 | 6123 wait_reading_process_input (sec, usec, zero, 0); |
| 6124 } | |
| 587 | 6125 |
|
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6126 /* We should always have wait_reading_process_input; we have a dummy |
|
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6127 implementation for systems which don't support subprocesses. */ |
|
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6128 #if 0 |
|
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6129 /* No wait_reading_process_input */ |
| 314 | 6130 immediate_quit = 1; |
| 6131 QUIT; | |
| 6132 | |
| 6133 #ifdef VMS | |
| 6134 sys_sleep (sec); | |
| 6135 #else /* not VMS */ | |
| 6136 /* The reason this is done this way | |
| 6137 (rather than defined (H_S) && defined (H_T)) | |
|
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
6138 is because the VMS preprocessor doesn't grok `defined'. */ |
| 314 | 6139 #ifdef HAVE_SELECT |
| 554 | 6140 EMACS_GET_TIME (end_time); |
| 6141 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (timeout, sec, usec); | |
| 587 | 6142 EMACS_ADD_TIME (end_time, end_time, timeout); |
| 554 | 6143 |
| 314 | 6144 while (1) |
| 6145 { | |
| 554 | 6146 EMACS_GET_TIME (timeout); |
| 6147 EMACS_SUB_TIME (timeout, end_time, timeout); | |
| 6148 if (EMACS_TIME_NEG_P (timeout) | |
| 6149 || !select (1, 0, 0, 0, &timeout)) | |
| 314 | 6150 break; |
| 6151 } | |
| 6152 #else /* not HAVE_SELECT */ | |
| 6153 sleep (sec); | |
| 6154 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */ | |
| 6155 #endif /* not VMS */ | |
| 6156 | |
| 6157 immediate_quit = 0; | |
| 6158 #endif /* no subprocesses */ | |
| 6159 | |
| 6160 return Qnil; | |
| 6161 } | |
| 6162 | |
| 25012 | 6163 |
| 650 | 6164 /* This is just like wait_reading_process_input, except that |
| 6165 it does the redisplay. | |
| 6166 | |
|
5223
db2e7e6a488e
(Fsit_for): Call prepare_menu_bars.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
5218
diff
changeset
|
6167 It's also much like Fsit_for, except that it can be used for |
|
11411
91bcce2fd486
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Ignore buffers whose names start with space.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
11235
diff
changeset
|
6168 waiting for input as well. */ |
| 650 | 6169 |
| 6170 Lisp_Object | |
|
17961
86ae1679df19
(sit_for): New arg initial_display.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17895
diff
changeset
|
6171 sit_for (sec, usec, reading, display, initial_display) |
|
86ae1679df19
(sit_for): New arg initial_display.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17895
diff
changeset
|
6172 int sec, usec, reading, display, initial_display; |
| 314 | 6173 { |
| 650 | 6174 Lisp_Object read_kbd; |
| 314 | 6175 |
|
14964
9938201005a3
(sit_for): Call swallow_events.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
14903
diff
changeset
|
6176 swallow_events (display); |
|
9938201005a3
(sit_for): Call swallow_events.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
14903
diff
changeset
|
6177 |
|
14757
99125e1e8bac
(sit_for): Pass DISPLAY to detect_input_pending_run_timers.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
14646
diff
changeset
|
6178 if (detect_input_pending_run_timers (display)) |
| 314 | 6179 return Qnil; |
| 650 | 6180 |
|
17961
86ae1679df19
(sit_for): New arg initial_display.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17895
diff
changeset
|
6181 if (initial_display) |
|
35336
002c02db42d3
Call redisplay_preserve_echo_area with additional arg.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35307
diff
changeset
|
6182 redisplay_preserve_echo_area (2); |
| 314 | 6183 |
| 673 | 6184 if (sec == 0 && usec == 0) |
| 6185 return Qt; | |
| 6186 | |
| 314 | 6187 #ifdef SIGIO |
|
1915
98ecf99d7b1a
* dispnew.c (sit_for): Pass the correct number of arguments to
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1872
diff
changeset
|
6188 gobble_input (0); |
| 650 | 6189 #endif |
| 6190 | |
|
9264
9338a124ea84
(redraw_frame, Fsleep_for, sit_for, Fsit_for): Use new accessor macros instead
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
8903
diff
changeset
|
6191 XSETINT (read_kbd, reading ? -1 : 1); |
| 650 | 6192 wait_reading_process_input (sec, usec, read_kbd, display); |
| 6193 | |
| 314 | 6194 return detect_input_pending () ? Qnil : Qt; |
| 6195 } | |
| 6196 | |
| 25012 | 6197 |
| 650 | 6198 DEFUN ("sit-for", Fsit_for, Ssit_for, 1, 3, 0, |
| 40979 | 6199 doc: /* Perform redisplay, then wait for SECONDS seconds or until input is available. |
|
39914
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6200 SECONDS may be a floating-point value, meaning that you can wait for a |
|
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6201 fraction of a second. Optional second arg MILLISECONDS specifies an |
|
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6202 additional wait period, in milliseconds; this may be useful if your |
|
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6203 Emacs was built without floating point support. |
|
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6204 \(Not all operating systems support waiting for a fraction of a second.) |
|
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6205 Optional third arg NODISP non-nil means don't redisplay, just wait for input. |
|
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6206 Redisplay is preempted as always if input arrives, and does not happen |
|
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6207 if input is available before it starts. |
|
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6208 Value is t if waited the full time with no input arriving. */) |
|
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6209 (seconds, milliseconds, nodisp) |
|
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6210 Lisp_Object seconds, milliseconds, nodisp; |
| 650 | 6211 { |
|
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6212 int sec, usec; |
| 650 | 6213 |
|
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6214 if (NILP (milliseconds)) |
|
9264
9338a124ea84
(redraw_frame, Fsleep_for, sit_for, Fsit_for): Use new accessor macros instead
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
8903
diff
changeset
|
6215 XSETINT (milliseconds, 0); |
|
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6216 else |
|
40656
cdfd4d09b79a
Update usage of CHECK_ macros (remove unused second argument).
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
40512
diff
changeset
|
6217 CHECK_NUMBER (milliseconds); |
| 2648 | 6218 usec = XINT (milliseconds) * 1000; |
| 6219 | |
| 6220 { | |
| 6221 double duration = extract_float (seconds); | |
| 6222 sec = (int) duration; | |
| 6223 usec += (duration - sec) * 1000000; | |
| 6224 } | |
|
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6225 |
| 650 | 6226 #ifndef EMACS_HAS_USECS |
|
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6227 if (usec != 0 && sec == 0) |
|
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6228 error ("millisecond `sit-for' not supported on %s", SYSTEM_TYPE); |
| 650 | 6229 #endif |
| 6230 | |
|
17961
86ae1679df19
(sit_for): New arg initial_display.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17895
diff
changeset
|
6231 return sit_for (sec, usec, 0, NILP (nodisp), NILP (nodisp)); |
| 650 | 6232 } |
| 25012 | 6233 |
| 6234 | |
| 314 | 6235 |
| 25012 | 6236 /*********************************************************************** |
| 6237 Other Lisp Functions | |
| 6238 ***********************************************************************/ | |
| 6239 | |
| 6240 /* A vector of size >= 2 * NFRAMES + 3 * NBUFFERS + 1, containing the | |
| 6241 session's frames, frame names, buffers, buffer-read-only flags, and | |
| 6242 buffer-modified-flags, and a trailing sentinel (so we don't need to | |
| 6243 add length checks). */ | |
| 6244 | |
| 6245 static Lisp_Object frame_and_buffer_state; | |
| 6246 | |
| 6247 | |
| 6248 DEFUN ("frame-or-buffer-changed-p", Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p, | |
|
39914
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6249 Sframe_or_buffer_changed_p, 0, 0, 0, |
| 40979 | 6250 doc: /* Return non-nil if the frame and buffer state appears to have changed. |
|
39914
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6251 The state variable is an internal vector containing all frames and buffers, |
|
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6252 aside from buffers whose names start with space, |
|
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6253 along with the buffers' read-only and modified flags, which allows a fast |
|
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6254 check to see whether the menu bars might need to be recomputed. |
|
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6255 If this function returns non-nil, it updates the internal vector to reflect |
|
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6256 the current state. */) |
|
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6257 () |
| 25012 | 6258 { |
| 6259 Lisp_Object tail, frame, buf; | |
| 6260 Lisp_Object *vecp; | |
| 6261 int n; | |
| 6262 | |
| 6263 vecp = XVECTOR (frame_and_buffer_state)->contents; | |
| 6264 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame) | |
| 6265 { | |
| 6266 if (!EQ (*vecp++, frame)) | |
| 6267 goto changed; | |
| 6268 if (!EQ (*vecp++, XFRAME (frame)->name)) | |
| 6269 goto changed; | |
| 6270 } | |
| 6271 /* Check that the buffer info matches. | |
| 6272 No need to test for the end of the vector | |
| 6273 because the last element of the vector is lambda | |
| 6274 and that will always cause a mismatch. */ | |
|
26164
d39ec0a27081
more XCAR/XCDR/XFLOAT_DATA uses, to help isolete lisp engine
Ken Raeburn <raeburn@raeburn.org>
parents:
26088
diff
changeset
|
6275 for (tail = Vbuffer_alist; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail)) |
| 25012 | 6276 { |
|
26164
d39ec0a27081
more XCAR/XCDR/XFLOAT_DATA uses, to help isolete lisp engine
Ken Raeburn <raeburn@raeburn.org>
parents:
26088
diff
changeset
|
6277 buf = XCDR (XCAR (tail)); |
| 25012 | 6278 /* Ignore buffers that aren't included in buffer lists. */ |
| 6279 if (XSTRING (XBUFFER (buf)->name)->data[0] == ' ') | |
| 6280 continue; | |
| 6281 if (!EQ (*vecp++, buf)) | |
| 6282 goto changed; | |
| 6283 if (!EQ (*vecp++, XBUFFER (buf)->read_only)) | |
| 6284 goto changed; | |
| 6285 if (!EQ (*vecp++, Fbuffer_modified_p (buf))) | |
| 6286 goto changed; | |
| 6287 } | |
| 6288 /* Detect deletion of a buffer at the end of the list. */ | |
| 6289 if (EQ (*vecp, Qlambda)) | |
| 6290 return Qnil; | |
| 6291 changed: | |
| 6292 /* Start with 1 so there is room for at least one lambda at the end. */ | |
| 6293 n = 1; | |
| 6294 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame) | |
| 6295 n += 2; | |
|
26164
d39ec0a27081
more XCAR/XCDR/XFLOAT_DATA uses, to help isolete lisp engine
Ken Raeburn <raeburn@raeburn.org>
parents:
26088
diff
changeset
|
6296 for (tail = Vbuffer_alist; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail)) |
| 25012 | 6297 n += 3; |
| 6298 /* Reallocate the vector if it's grown, or if it's shrunk a lot. */ | |
| 6299 if (n > XVECTOR (frame_and_buffer_state)->size | |
| 6300 || n + 20 < XVECTOR (frame_and_buffer_state)->size / 2) | |
| 6301 /* Add 20 extra so we grow it less often. */ | |
| 6302 frame_and_buffer_state = Fmake_vector (make_number (n + 20), Qlambda); | |
| 6303 vecp = XVECTOR (frame_and_buffer_state)->contents; | |
| 6304 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame) | |
| 6305 { | |
| 6306 *vecp++ = frame; | |
| 6307 *vecp++ = XFRAME (frame)->name; | |
| 6308 } | |
|
26164
d39ec0a27081
more XCAR/XCDR/XFLOAT_DATA uses, to help isolete lisp engine
Ken Raeburn <raeburn@raeburn.org>
parents:
26088
diff
changeset
|
6309 for (tail = Vbuffer_alist; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail)) |
| 25012 | 6310 { |
|
26164
d39ec0a27081
more XCAR/XCDR/XFLOAT_DATA uses, to help isolete lisp engine
Ken Raeburn <raeburn@raeburn.org>
parents:
26088
diff
changeset
|
6311 buf = XCDR (XCAR (tail)); |
| 25012 | 6312 /* Ignore buffers that aren't included in buffer lists. */ |
| 6313 if (XSTRING (XBUFFER (buf)->name)->data[0] == ' ') | |
| 6314 continue; | |
| 6315 *vecp++ = buf; | |
| 6316 *vecp++ = XBUFFER (buf)->read_only; | |
| 6317 *vecp++ = Fbuffer_modified_p (buf); | |
| 6318 } | |
| 6319 /* Fill up the vector with lambdas (always at least one). */ | |
| 6320 *vecp++ = Qlambda; | |
| 6321 while (vecp - XVECTOR (frame_and_buffer_state)->contents | |
| 6322 < XVECTOR (frame_and_buffer_state)->size) | |
| 6323 *vecp++ = Qlambda; | |
| 6324 /* Make sure we didn't overflow the vector. */ | |
| 6325 if (vecp - XVECTOR (frame_and_buffer_state)->contents | |
| 6326 > XVECTOR (frame_and_buffer_state)->size) | |
| 6327 abort (); | |
| 6328 return Qt; | |
| 6329 } | |
| 6330 | |
| 6331 | |
| 6332 | |
| 6333 /*********************************************************************** | |
| 6334 Initialization | |
| 6335 ***********************************************************************/ | |
| 6336 | |
| 314 | 6337 char *terminal_type; |
| 6338 | |
| 25012 | 6339 /* Initialization done when Emacs fork is started, before doing stty. |
| 6340 Determine terminal type and set terminal_driver. Then invoke its | |
| 6341 decoding routine to set up variables in the terminal package. */ | |
| 314 | 6342 |
| 21514 | 6343 void |
| 314 | 6344 init_display () |
| 6345 { | |
| 6346 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS | |
| 6347 extern int display_arg; | |
| 6348 #endif | |
| 6349 | |
| 25012 | 6350 /* Construct the space glyph. */ |
| 6351 space_glyph.type = CHAR_GLYPH; | |
| 6352 SET_CHAR_GLYPH_FROM_GLYPH (space_glyph, ' '); | |
| 6353 space_glyph.charpos = -1; | |
| 6354 | |
| 314 | 6355 meta_key = 0; |
| 6356 inverse_video = 0; | |
| 6357 cursor_in_echo_area = 0; | |
| 6358 terminal_type = (char *) 0; | |
| 6359 | |
|
2339
a302de11debf
* dispnew.c (init_display): Initialize Vwindow_system.
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2292
diff
changeset
|
6360 /* Now is the time to initialize this; it's used by init_sys_modes |
|
a302de11debf
* dispnew.c (init_display): Initialize Vwindow_system.
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2292
diff
changeset
|
6361 during startup. */ |
|
a302de11debf
* dispnew.c (init_display): Initialize Vwindow_system.
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2292
diff
changeset
|
6362 Vwindow_system = Qnil; |
| 314 | 6363 |
|
2339
a302de11debf
* dispnew.c (init_display): Initialize Vwindow_system.
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2292
diff
changeset
|
6364 /* If the user wants to use a window system, we shouldn't bother |
|
a302de11debf
* dispnew.c (init_display): Initialize Vwindow_system.
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2292
diff
changeset
|
6365 initializing the terminal. This is especially important when the |
|
a302de11debf
* dispnew.c (init_display): Initialize Vwindow_system.
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2292
diff
changeset
|
6366 terminal is so dumb that emacs gives up before and doesn't bother |
|
a302de11debf
* dispnew.c (init_display): Initialize Vwindow_system.
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2292
diff
changeset
|
6367 using the window system. |
|
a302de11debf
* dispnew.c (init_display): Initialize Vwindow_system.
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2292
diff
changeset
|
6368 |
|
14125
2f222e8b06f5
(init_display): Treat null string DISPLAY var like not set.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14068
diff
changeset
|
6369 If the DISPLAY environment variable is set and nonempty, |
|
2f222e8b06f5
(init_display): Treat null string DISPLAY var like not set.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14068
diff
changeset
|
6370 try to use X, and die with an error message if that doesn't work. */ |
| 314 | 6371 |
| 6372 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS | |
|
2359
90a5f91329f3
* dispnew.c (init_display): Get display name from environment
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2339
diff
changeset
|
6373 if (! display_arg) |
|
90a5f91329f3
* dispnew.c (init_display): Get display name from environment
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2339
diff
changeset
|
6374 { |
|
14125
2f222e8b06f5
(init_display): Treat null string DISPLAY var like not set.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14068
diff
changeset
|
6375 char *display; |
|
2359
90a5f91329f3
* dispnew.c (init_display): Get display name from environment
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2339
diff
changeset
|
6376 #ifdef VMS |
|
14125
2f222e8b06f5
(init_display): Treat null string DISPLAY var like not set.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14068
diff
changeset
|
6377 display = getenv ("DECW$DISPLAY"); |
|
2359
90a5f91329f3
* dispnew.c (init_display): Get display name from environment
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2339
diff
changeset
|
6378 #else |
|
14125
2f222e8b06f5
(init_display): Treat null string DISPLAY var like not set.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14068
diff
changeset
|
6379 display = getenv ("DISPLAY"); |
|
2359
90a5f91329f3
* dispnew.c (init_display): Get display name from environment
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2339
diff
changeset
|
6380 #endif |
|
14125
2f222e8b06f5
(init_display): Treat null string DISPLAY var like not set.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14068
diff
changeset
|
6381 |
|
2f222e8b06f5
(init_display): Treat null string DISPLAY var like not set.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14068
diff
changeset
|
6382 display_arg = (display != 0 && *display != 0); |
| 2364 | 6383 } |
|
2359
90a5f91329f3
* dispnew.c (init_display): Get display name from environment
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2339
diff
changeset
|
6384 |
|
18774
95b4ac950a5d
(init_display): Go ahead and prepare for
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
18015
diff
changeset
|
6385 if (!inhibit_window_system && display_arg |
|
95b4ac950a5d
(init_display): Go ahead and prepare for
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
18015
diff
changeset
|
6386 #ifndef CANNOT_DUMP |
|
95b4ac950a5d
(init_display): Go ahead and prepare for
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
18015
diff
changeset
|
6387 && initialized |
|
95b4ac950a5d
(init_display): Go ahead and prepare for
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
18015
diff
changeset
|
6388 #endif |
|
95b4ac950a5d
(init_display): Go ahead and prepare for
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
18015
diff
changeset
|
6389 ) |
| 314 | 6390 { |
| 6391 Vwindow_system = intern ("x"); | |
| 6392 #ifdef HAVE_X11 | |
| 6393 Vwindow_system_version = make_number (11); | |
| 6394 #else | |
| 6395 Vwindow_system_version = make_number (10); | |
| 6396 #endif | |
|
41969
e669966d496e
Test GNU_LINUX, not LINUX.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
41120
diff
changeset
|
6397 #if defined (GNU_LINUX) && defined (HAVE_LIBNCURSES) |
|
15273
db889dd732a1
(init_display) [HAVE_LIBNCURSES]: If X, call tgetent.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
15078
diff
changeset
|
6398 /* In some versions of ncurses, |
| 15282 | 6399 tputs crashes if we have not called tgetent. |
|
15273
db889dd732a1
(init_display) [HAVE_LIBNCURSES]: If X, call tgetent.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
15078
diff
changeset
|
6400 So call tgetent. */ |
|
db889dd732a1
(init_display) [HAVE_LIBNCURSES]: If X, call tgetent.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
15078
diff
changeset
|
6401 { char b[2044]; tgetent (b, "xterm");} |
|
db889dd732a1
(init_display) [HAVE_LIBNCURSES]: If X, call tgetent.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
15078
diff
changeset
|
6402 #endif |
| 25012 | 6403 adjust_frame_glyphs_initially (); |
| 314 | 6404 return; |
| 6405 } | |
| 6406 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */ | |
| 6407 | |
|
13408
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
6408 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI |
|
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
6409 if (!inhibit_window_system) |
|
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
6410 { |
|
16589
ec300a10e407
(init_display) [HAVE_NTGUI]: Use w32 for window-system.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
16412
diff
changeset
|
6411 Vwindow_system = intern ("w32"); |
|
13408
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
6412 Vwindow_system_version = make_number (1); |
| 25012 | 6413 adjust_frame_glyphs_initially (); |
|
13408
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
6414 return; |
|
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
6415 } |
|
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
6416 #endif /* HAVE_NTGUI */ |
|
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
6417 |
|
32752
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
6418 #ifdef macintosh |
|
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
6419 if (!inhibit_window_system) |
|
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
6420 { |
|
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
6421 Vwindow_system = intern ("mac"); |
|
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
6422 Vwindow_system_version = make_number (1); |
|
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
6423 adjust_frame_glyphs_initially (); |
|
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
6424 return; |
|
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
6425 } |
|
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
6426 #endif /* macintosh */ |
|
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
6427 |
| 314 | 6428 /* If no window system has been specified, try to use the terminal. */ |
| 6429 if (! isatty (0)) | |
| 6430 { | |
|
16896
b2c51d6de440
(init_display): Use `fatal'.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16891
diff
changeset
|
6431 fatal ("standard input is not a tty"); |
| 314 | 6432 exit (1); |
| 6433 } | |
| 6434 | |
|
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
6435 /* Look at the TERM variable. */ |
| 314 | 6436 terminal_type = (char *) getenv ("TERM"); |
| 6437 if (!terminal_type) | |
| 6438 { | |
| 6439 #ifdef VMS | |
| 6440 fprintf (stderr, "Please specify your terminal type.\n\ | |
| 6441 For types defined in VMS, use set term /device=TYPE.\n\ | |
| 6442 For types not defined in VMS, use define emacs_term \"TYPE\".\n\ | |
| 6443 \(The quotation marks are necessary since terminal types are lower case.)\n"); | |
| 6444 #else | |
| 6445 fprintf (stderr, "Please set the environment variable TERM; see tset(1).\n"); | |
| 6446 #endif | |
| 6447 exit (1); | |
| 6448 } | |
| 6449 | |
| 6450 #ifdef VMS | |
| 25012 | 6451 /* VMS DCL tends to up-case things, so down-case term type. |
| 314 | 6452 Hardly any uppercase letters in terminal types; should be none. */ |
| 6453 { | |
| 6454 char *new = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (terminal_type) + 1); | |
| 6455 char *p; | |
| 6456 | |
| 6457 strcpy (new, terminal_type); | |
| 6458 | |
| 6459 for (p = new; *p; p++) | |
| 6460 if (isupper (*p)) | |
| 6461 *p = tolower (*p); | |
| 6462 | |
| 6463 terminal_type = new; | |
| 6464 } | |
| 25012 | 6465 #endif /* VMS */ |
| 314 | 6466 |
| 6467 term_init (terminal_type); | |
| 25012 | 6468 |
|
16891
989845750a4d
(init_display): Check for overflow in screen size.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16881
diff
changeset
|
6469 { |
|
25666
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
6470 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME (); |
|
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
6471 int width = FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (sf); |
|
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
6472 int height = FRAME_HEIGHT (sf); |
|
16891
989845750a4d
(init_display): Check for overflow in screen size.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16881
diff
changeset
|
6473 |
| 25012 | 6474 unsigned int total_glyphs = height * (width + 2) * sizeof (struct glyph); |
| 6475 | |
| 6476 /* If these sizes are so big they cause overflow, just ignore the | |
| 6477 change. It's not clear what better we could do. */ | |
| 6478 if (total_glyphs / sizeof (struct glyph) / height != width + 2) | |
|
16896
b2c51d6de440
(init_display): Use `fatal'.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16891
diff
changeset
|
6479 fatal ("screen size %dx%d too big", width, height); |
|
16891
989845750a4d
(init_display): Check for overflow in screen size.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16881
diff
changeset
|
6480 } |
|
989845750a4d
(init_display): Check for overflow in screen size.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16881
diff
changeset
|
6481 |
| 25012 | 6482 adjust_frame_glyphs_initially (); |
|
25666
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
6483 calculate_costs (XFRAME (selected_frame)); |
| 314 | 6484 |
| 6485 #ifdef SIGWINCH | |
| 6486 #ifndef CANNOT_DUMP | |
| 6487 if (initialized) | |
| 6488 #endif /* CANNOT_DUMP */ | |
| 6489 signal (SIGWINCH, window_change_signal); | |
| 6490 #endif /* SIGWINCH */ | |
| 25012 | 6491 |
| 6492 /* Set up faces of the initial terminal frame of a dumped Emacs. */ | |
| 6493 if (initialized | |
| 6494 && !noninteractive | |
|
25118
08ae9ffe6763
(init_display) [MSDOS]: Don't initialize frame faces,
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
25012
diff
changeset
|
6495 #ifdef MSDOS |
|
08ae9ffe6763
(init_display) [MSDOS]: Don't initialize frame faces,
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
25012
diff
changeset
|
6496 /* The MSDOS terminal turns on its ``window system'' relatively |
|
08ae9ffe6763
(init_display) [MSDOS]: Don't initialize frame faces,
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
25012
diff
changeset
|
6497 late into the startup, so we cannot do the frame faces' |
|
08ae9ffe6763
(init_display) [MSDOS]: Don't initialize frame faces,
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
25012
diff
changeset
|
6498 initialization just yet. It will be done later by pc-win.el |
|
08ae9ffe6763
(init_display) [MSDOS]: Don't initialize frame faces,
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
25012
diff
changeset
|
6499 and internal_terminal_init. */ |
|
08ae9ffe6763
(init_display) [MSDOS]: Don't initialize frame faces,
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
25012
diff
changeset
|
6500 && (strcmp (terminal_type, "internal") != 0 || inhibit_window_system) |
|
08ae9ffe6763
(init_display) [MSDOS]: Don't initialize frame faces,
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
25012
diff
changeset
|
6501 #endif |
| 25012 | 6502 && NILP (Vwindow_system)) |
|
26729
f5dded41adcc
Changes for automatic remapping of X colors on terminal frames:
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
26591
diff
changeset
|
6503 { |
|
f5dded41adcc
Changes for automatic remapping of X colors on terminal frames:
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
26591
diff
changeset
|
6504 /* For the initial frame, we don't have any way of knowing what |
|
f5dded41adcc
Changes for automatic remapping of X colors on terminal frames:
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
26591
diff
changeset
|
6505 are the foreground and background colors of the terminal. */ |
|
f5dded41adcc
Changes for automatic remapping of X colors on terminal frames:
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
26591
diff
changeset
|
6506 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME(); |
|
f5dded41adcc
Changes for automatic remapping of X colors on terminal frames:
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
26591
diff
changeset
|
6507 |
|
26902
264b83a3a688
Changes for separate unspecified foreground and background colors
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
26851
diff
changeset
|
6508 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (sf) = FACE_TTY_DEFAULT_FG_COLOR; |
|
264b83a3a688
Changes for separate unspecified foreground and background colors
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
26851
diff
changeset
|
6509 FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (sf) = FACE_TTY_DEFAULT_BG_COLOR; |
|
26729
f5dded41adcc
Changes for automatic remapping of X colors on terminal frames:
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
26591
diff
changeset
|
6510 call0 (intern ("tty-set-up-initial-frame-faces")); |
|
f5dded41adcc
Changes for automatic remapping of X colors on terminal frames:
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
26591
diff
changeset
|
6511 } |
| 314 | 6512 } |
| 25012 | 6513 |
| 6514 | |
| 314 | 6515 |
| 25012 | 6516 /*********************************************************************** |
| 6517 Blinking cursor | |
| 6518 ***********************************************************************/ | |
| 6519 | |
|
26280
083835afced5
(Finternal_show_cursor): Renamed from Fshow_cursor.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26164
diff
changeset
|
6520 DEFUN ("internal-show-cursor", Finternal_show_cursor, |
|
26334
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6521 Sinternal_show_cursor, 2, 2, 0, |
|
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6522 doc: /* Set the cursor-visibility flag of WINDOW to SHOW. |
|
39914
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6523 WINDOW nil means use the selected window. SHOW non-nil means |
|
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6524 show a cursor in WINDOW in the next redisplay. SHOW nil means |
|
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6525 don't show a cursor. */) |
|
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6526 (window, show) |
|
26334
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6527 Lisp_Object window, show; |
| 25012 | 6528 { |
| 6529 /* Don't change cursor state while redisplaying. This could confuse | |
| 6530 output routines. */ | |
| 6531 if (!redisplaying_p) | |
| 6532 { | |
| 6533 if (NILP (window)) | |
| 6534 window = selected_window; | |
| 6535 else | |
|
40656
cdfd4d09b79a
Update usage of CHECK_ macros (remove unused second argument).
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
40512
diff
changeset
|
6536 CHECK_WINDOW (window); |
| 25012 | 6537 |
|
26334
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6538 XWINDOW (window)->cursor_off_p = NILP (show); |
| 25012 | 6539 } |
| 6540 | |
| 6541 return Qnil; | |
| 6542 } | |
| 6543 | |
| 6544 | |
|
26334
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6545 DEFUN ("internal-show-cursor-p", Finternal_show_cursor_p, |
|
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6546 Sinternal_show_cursor_p, 0, 1, 0, |
| 40979 | 6547 doc: /* Value is non-nil if next redisplay will display a cursor in WINDOW. |
|
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6548 WINDOW nil or omitted means report on the selected window. */) |
|
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6549 (window) |
|
26334
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6550 Lisp_Object window; |
|
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6551 { |
|
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6552 struct window *w; |
|
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6553 |
|
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6554 if (NILP (window)) |
|
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6555 window = selected_window; |
|
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6556 else |
|
40656
cdfd4d09b79a
Update usage of CHECK_ macros (remove unused second argument).
Pavel Jan?k <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
40512
diff
changeset
|
6557 CHECK_WINDOW (window); |
|
26334
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6558 |
|
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6559 w = XWINDOW (window); |
|
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6560 return w->cursor_off_p ? Qnil : Qt; |
|
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6561 } |
|
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6562 |
| 25012 | 6563 |
| 6564 /*********************************************************************** | |
| 6565 Initialization | |
| 6566 ***********************************************************************/ | |
| 6567 | |
| 21514 | 6568 void |
| 314 | 6569 syms_of_display () |
| 6570 { | |
| 764 | 6571 defsubr (&Sredraw_frame); |
| 314 | 6572 defsubr (&Sredraw_display); |
|
7810
15c0bf73737e
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): New function.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
7808
diff
changeset
|
6573 defsubr (&Sframe_or_buffer_changed_p); |
| 314 | 6574 defsubr (&Sopen_termscript); |
| 6575 defsubr (&Sding); | |
| 6576 defsubr (&Ssit_for); | |
| 6577 defsubr (&Ssleep_for); | |
| 6578 defsubr (&Ssend_string_to_terminal); | |
|
26280
083835afced5
(Finternal_show_cursor): Renamed from Fshow_cursor.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26164
diff
changeset
|
6579 defsubr (&Sinternal_show_cursor); |
|
26334
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6580 defsubr (&Sinternal_show_cursor_p); |
| 314 | 6581 |
|
34893
779bd3fa820e
Use #if GLYPH_DEBUG instead of #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34866
diff
changeset
|
6582 #if GLYPH_DEBUG |
|
34866
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
6583 defsubr (&Sdump_redisplay_history); |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
6584 #endif |
|
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
6585 |
|
12186
6811992e871c
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Calculate vector size right.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
11919
diff
changeset
|
6586 frame_and_buffer_state = Fmake_vector (make_number (20), Qlambda); |
|
7810
15c0bf73737e
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): New function.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
7808
diff
changeset
|
6587 staticpro (&frame_and_buffer_state); |
|
15c0bf73737e
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): New function.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
7808
diff
changeset
|
6588 |
|
13220
2e9014617492
(Qdisplay_table): New variable.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13105
diff
changeset
|
6589 Qdisplay_table = intern ("display-table"); |
|
2e9014617492
(Qdisplay_table): New variable.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13105
diff
changeset
|
6590 staticpro (&Qdisplay_table); |
|
30720
64f3338f72d8
(Qredisplay_dont_pause): New variable.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30713
diff
changeset
|
6591 Qredisplay_dont_pause = intern ("redisplay-dont-pause"); |
|
64f3338f72d8
(Qredisplay_dont_pause): New variable.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30713
diff
changeset
|
6592 staticpro (&Qredisplay_dont_pause); |
|
13220
2e9014617492
(Qdisplay_table): New variable.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13105
diff
changeset
|
6593 |
|
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6594 DEFVAR_INT ("baud-rate", &baud_rate, |
| 40979 | 6595 doc: /* *The output baud rate of the terminal. |
|
39914
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6596 On most systems, changing this value will affect the amount of padding |
|
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6597 and the other strategic decisions made during redisplay. */); |
| 25012 | 6598 |
|
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6599 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inverse-video", &inverse_video, |
| 40979 | 6600 doc: /* *Non-nil means invert the entire frame display. |
|
39914
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6601 This means everything is in inverse video which otherwise would not be. */); |
| 25012 | 6602 |
|
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6603 DEFVAR_BOOL ("visible-bell", &visible_bell, |
| 40979 | 6604 doc: /* *Non-nil means try to flash the frame to represent a bell. |
|
40334
bee6cc2e8a90
(syms_of_display) <visible-bell>: Add a reference to
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
40271
diff
changeset
|
6605 |
|
bee6cc2e8a90
(syms_of_display) <visible-bell>: Add a reference to
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
40271
diff
changeset
|
6606 See also `ring-bell-function'. */); |
| 25012 | 6607 |
|
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6608 DEFVAR_BOOL ("no-redraw-on-reenter", &no_redraw_on_reenter, |
| 40979 | 6609 doc: /* *Non-nil means no need to redraw entire frame after suspending. |
|
39914
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6610 A non-nil value is useful if the terminal can automatically preserve |
|
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6611 Emacs's frame display when you reenter Emacs. |
|
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6612 It is up to you to set this variable if your terminal can do that. */); |
| 25012 | 6613 |
|
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6614 DEFVAR_LISP ("window-system", &Vwindow_system, |
|
41025
4feeae90afa4
(syms_of_display): Doc fix.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
40979
diff
changeset
|
6615 doc: /* Name of window system that Emacs is displaying through. |
|
4feeae90afa4
(syms_of_display): Doc fix.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
40979
diff
changeset
|
6616 The value is a symbol--for instance, `x' for X windows. |
|
4feeae90afa4
(syms_of_display): Doc fix.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
40979
diff
changeset
|
6617 The value is nil if Emacs is using a text-only terminal. */); |
| 25012 | 6618 |
|
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6619 DEFVAR_LISP ("window-system-version", &Vwindow_system_version, |
| 40979 | 6620 doc: /* The version number of the window system in use. |
|
39914
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6621 For X windows, this is 10 or 11. */); |
| 25012 | 6622 |
|
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6623 DEFVAR_BOOL ("cursor-in-echo-area", &cursor_in_echo_area, |
| 40979 | 6624 doc: /* Non-nil means put cursor in minibuffer, at end of any message there. */); |
| 25012 | 6625 |
|
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6626 DEFVAR_LISP ("glyph-table", &Vglyph_table, |
| 40979 | 6627 doc: /* Table defining how to output a glyph code to the frame. |
|
39914
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6628 If not nil, this is a vector indexed by glyph code to define the glyph. |
|
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6629 Each element can be: |
|
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6630 integer: a glyph code which this glyph is an alias for. |
|
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6631 string: output this glyph using that string (not impl. in X windows). |
|
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6632 nil: this glyph mod 524288 is the code of a character to output, |
|
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6633 and this glyph / 524288 is the face number (see `face-id') to use |
|
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6634 while outputting it. */); |
| 314 | 6635 Vglyph_table = Qnil; |
| 6636 | |
|
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6637 DEFVAR_LISP ("standard-display-table", &Vstandard_display_table, |
| 40979 | 6638 doc: /* Display table to use for buffers that specify none. |
|
39914
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6639 See `buffer-display-table' for more information. */); |
| 314 | 6640 Vstandard_display_table = Qnil; |
| 6641 | |
|
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6642 DEFVAR_BOOL ("redisplay-dont-pause", &redisplay_dont_pause, |
| 40979 | 6643 doc: /* *Non-nil means update isn't paused when input is detected. */); |
| 25012 | 6644 redisplay_dont_pause = 0; |
| 6645 | |
| 314 | 6646 /* Initialize `window-system', unless init_display already decided it. */ |
| 6647 #ifdef CANNOT_DUMP | |
| 6648 if (noninteractive) | |
| 6649 #endif | |
| 6650 { | |
| 6651 Vwindow_system = Qnil; | |
| 6652 Vwindow_system_version = Qnil; | |
| 6653 } | |
| 6654 } |
